blob: 9e45c391814985d7ef64aa72d1969ba0fc485f65 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau16f863f2015-07-03 17:35:11 +02005 version 1.5.14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau16f863f2015-07-03 17:35:11 +02007 2015/07/02
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200500 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100501 - tune.zlib.memlevel
502 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504 * Debugging
505 - debug
506 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200507
508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005093.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200510------------------------------------
511
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200512ca-base <dir>
513 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200514 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
515 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517chroot <jail dir>
518 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
519 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
520 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
521 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
522 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
523 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100524
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100525cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
526 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
527 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
528 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100529 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
530 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
531 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
532 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
533 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
534 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
535 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
536 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
537 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
538 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100539
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200540crt-base <dir>
541 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
542 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
543 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
544
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545daemon
546 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
547 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
548 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
549
550gid <number>
551 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
552 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
553 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100554 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
555 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100557
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558group <group name>
559 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
560 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100561
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200562log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
564 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100565 configured with "log global".
566
567 <address> can be one of:
568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100569 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100570 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
571 port).
572
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100573 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
574 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
575 port).
576
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100577 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
578 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
579 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
580 writeable).
581
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100582 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
583 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
584 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
585 in Bourne shell.
586
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200587 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
588 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
589 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
590 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
591 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
592 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
593 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
594 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
595 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
596 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
597 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
598
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100599 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600
601 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
602 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
603 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
604
605 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200606 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
607 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
608 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
609 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
610 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
611 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200613 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100615log-send-hostname [<string>]
616 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
617 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
618 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
619 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
620 the logs.
621
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000622log-tag <string>
623 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
624 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
625 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
626 running on the same host.
627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200628nbproc <number>
629 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
630 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
631 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
632 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
633 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
634
635pidfile <pidfile>
636 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
637 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
638 starting the process. See also "daemon".
639
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100640stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200641 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
642 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
643 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
644 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
645 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
646 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100647 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200648 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
649 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200650
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100651ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
652 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
653 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300654 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100655 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
656 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
657 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
658 "bind" keyword for more information.
659
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100660ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
662 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
663 keyword to see available options.
664
665 Example:
666 global
667 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
668
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100669ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
670 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
671 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300672 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100673 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
674 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
675 information.
676
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100677ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
678 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
679 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
680 keyword to see available options.
681
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100682ssl-server-verify [none|required]
683 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
684 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
685 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
686
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200687stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
688 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
689 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
690 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
691 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200692
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200693 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
694 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
695 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200696
697stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
698 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
699 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100700 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200701
702stats maxconn <connections>
703 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
704 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
705
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706uid <number>
707 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
708 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
709 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
710 one. See also "gid" and "user".
711
712ulimit-n <number>
713 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
714 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
715 option.
716
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100717unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
718 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
719
720 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
721 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
722 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
723 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
724 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
725 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
726 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
727 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
728 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
729 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731user <user name>
732 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
733 See also "uid" and "group".
734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200735node <name>
736 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
737
738 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
739 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
740 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
741 traffic.
742
743description <text>
744 Add a text that describes the instance.
745
746 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
747 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
748 "<" and ">" characters.
749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007513.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200752-----------------------
753
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200754max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
755 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
756 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
757 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
758 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
759 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
760 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
761 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
762 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
763
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200764maxconn <number>
765 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
766 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
767 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200768 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
769 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
770 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
771 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
772 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200773
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200774maxconnrate <number>
775 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
776 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
777 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
778 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
779 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
780 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
781 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
782 fairness.
783
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100784maxcomprate <number>
785 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300786 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100787 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
788 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
789 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
790 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
791 default value.
792
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100793maxcompcpuusage <number>
794 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
795 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
796 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
797 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
798 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
799 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
800 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
801 process down and from introducing high latencies.
802
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100803maxpipes <number>
804 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
805 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
806 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
807 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
808 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
809 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
810
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200811maxsessrate <number>
812 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
813 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
814 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
815 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
816 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
817 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
818 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
819 fairness.
820
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200821maxsslconn <number>
822 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
823 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
824 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
825 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
826 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
827 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
828 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
829
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200830maxsslrate <number>
831 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
832 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
833 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
834 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
835 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
836 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
837 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
838 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
839 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
840 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
841
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100842maxzlibmem <number>
843 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
844 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
845 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100846 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
847 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
848 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
849
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200850noepoll
851 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
852 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100853 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200854
855nokqueue
856 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
857 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
858 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
859
860nopoll
861 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
862 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100863 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100864 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200865
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100866nosplice
867 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
868 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
869 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100870 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100871 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
872 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
873 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
874 "option splice-response".
875
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300876nogetaddrinfo
877 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
878 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
879
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200880spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900881 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
882 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
883 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
884 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
885 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
886 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200887
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200888tune.bufsize <number>
889 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
890 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
891 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
892 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
893 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
894 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
895 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
896 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400897 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
898 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
899 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200900
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200901tune.chksize <number>
902 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
903 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
904 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
905 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
906 checks whenever possible.
907
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100908tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
909 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
910 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
911 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
912 this value. The default value is 1.
913
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100914tune.http.cookielen <number>
915 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
916 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
917 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
918 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
919 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
920 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
921 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
922 to change this value.
923
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200924tune.http.maxhdr <number>
925 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
926 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
927 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
928 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
929 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
930 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
931 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
932 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
933 limit too high.
934
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100935tune.idletimer <timeout>
936 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
937 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
938 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
939 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
940 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
941 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
942 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
943 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
944 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
945
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100946tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100947 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
948 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
949 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
950 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
951 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
952 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
953 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
954 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
955 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
956 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100957
958tune.maxpollevents <number>
959 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
960 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
961 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
962 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
963 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
964
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200965tune.maxrewrite <number>
966 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
967 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
968 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
969 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
970 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
971 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
972 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
973 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
974 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
975 bufsize.
976
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200977tune.pipesize <number>
978 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
979 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
980 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
981 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
982 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
983 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
984
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100985tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
986tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
987 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
988 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
989 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
990 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
991 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
992 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
993 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
994
995tune.sndbuf.client <number>
996tune.sndbuf.server <number>
997 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
998 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
999 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1000 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1001 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1002 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1003 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1004 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1005 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1006 notifying haproxy again.
1007
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001008tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001009 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1010 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1011 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001012 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001013 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1014 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1015 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1016 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1017 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001018 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1019 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001020
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001021tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1022 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1023 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1024 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1025 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1026 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1027 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1028
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001029tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1030 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001031 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001032 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1033 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1034 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1035 being used for too long.
1036
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001037tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1038 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1039 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1040 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1041 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1042 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1043 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1044 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1045 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1046 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1047 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001048 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1049 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001050
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001051tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1052 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1053 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1054 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1055 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1056 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1057 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1058 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1059 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1060
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001061tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1062 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001063 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001064 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1065 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1066 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1067
1068tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1069 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1070 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1071 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1072 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010743.3. Debugging
1075--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
1077debug
1078 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1079 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1080 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1081 system startup.
1082
1083quiet
1084 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1085 line argument "-q".
1086
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010883.4. Userlists
1089--------------
1090It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1091http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1092it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1093
1094userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001095 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001096 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1097
1098group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001099 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001100 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1101 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1102
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001103user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1104 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001105 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1106 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001107 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1108 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001109 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001110 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001111
1112
1113 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001114 userlist L1
1115 group G1 users tiger,scott
1116 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001117
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001118 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1119 user scott insecure-password elgato
1120 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001121
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001122 userlist L2
1123 group G1
1124 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001125
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001126 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1127 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1128 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001129
1130 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001131
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001132
11333.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001134----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001135It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1136haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1137pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1138identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1139or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1140Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1141known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1142the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1143process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1144during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1145tables.
1146
1147peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001148 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001149 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1150
Willy Tarreau34d05b02015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001151disabled
1152 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1153 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1154 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1155
1156enable
1157 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1158
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001159peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1160 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1161 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1162 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1163 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1164 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1165 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1166
1167 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1168 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1169
1170 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1171 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1172 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1173 across all peers.
1174
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001175 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1176 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1177 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1178
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001179 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001180 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001181 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1182 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1183 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001184
1185 backend mybackend
1186 mode tcp
1187 balance roundrobin
1188 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1189 stick on src
1190
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001191 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1192 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001193
1194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011954. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001196----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001197
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001198Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1199 - defaults <name>
1200 - frontend <name>
1201 - backend <name>
1202 - listen <name>
1203
1204A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1205its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1206section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001207section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001208
1209A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1210connections.
1211
1212A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1213to forward incoming connections.
1214
1215A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1216parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1217
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001218All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1219'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1220case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1221
1222Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1223logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1224proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1225However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1226name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1227
1228Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1229and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001230bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001231protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1232modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1233arbitrary criteria.
1234
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001235In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1236a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1237the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1238
1239 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1240 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1241 between responses and new requests.
1242
1243 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1244 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1245 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1246 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1247
1248 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1249 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1250 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1251
1252 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1253 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1254 client-facing connection remains open.
1255
1256 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1257 after the end of the response.
1258
1259The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1260frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1261following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1262weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1263
1264 Backend mode
1265
1266 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1267 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1268 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1269 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1270 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1271 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1272 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1273 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1274 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1275 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1276 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1277
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001278
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012804.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1281--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001283The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1284limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1285they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1286limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001287marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001288option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001289and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1290with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1291specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001292
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001293
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001294 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1295------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1296acl - X X X
1297appsession - - X X
1298backlog X X X -
1299balance X - X X
1300bind - X X -
1301bind-process X X X X
1302block - X X X
1303capture cookie - X X -
1304capture request header - X X -
1305capture response header - X X -
1306clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001307compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001308contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1309cookie X - X X
1310default-server X - X X
1311default_backend X X X -
1312description - X X X
1313disabled X X X X
1314dispatch - - X X
1315enabled X X X X
1316errorfile X X X X
1317errorloc X X X X
1318errorloc302 X X X X
1319-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1320errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001321force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001322fullconn X - X X
1323grace X X X X
1324hash-type X - X X
1325http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001326http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001327http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001328http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001329http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001330http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001331id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001332ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001333log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001334log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001335max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001336maxconn X X X -
1337mode X X X X
1338monitor fail - X X -
1339monitor-net X X X -
1340monitor-uri X X X -
1341option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1342option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1343option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1344option allbackups (*) X - X X
1345option checkcache (*) X - X X
1346option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1347option contstats (*) X X X -
1348option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1349option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1350option forceclose (*) X X X X
1351-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1352option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreaub17e8b92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001353option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001354option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001355option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001356option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001357option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001358option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001359option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1360option httpchk X - X X
1361option httpclose (*) X X X X
1362option httplog X X X X
1363option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001364option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001365option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001366option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1367option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1368option logasap (*) X X X -
1369option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001370option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001371option nolinger (*) X X X X
1372option originalto X X X X
1373option persist (*) X - X X
1374option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001375option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001376option smtpchk X - X X
1377option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1378option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1379option splice-request (*) X X X X
1380option splice-response (*) X X X X
1381option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1382option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1383-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001384option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001385option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1386option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1387option tcpka X X X X
1388option tcplog X X X X
1389option transparent (*) X - X X
1390persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1391rate-limit sessions X X X -
1392redirect - X X X
1393redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1394redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1395reqadd - X X X
1396reqallow - X X X
1397reqdel - X X X
1398reqdeny - X X X
1399reqiallow - X X X
1400reqidel - X X X
1401reqideny - X X X
1402reqipass - X X X
1403reqirep - X X X
1404reqisetbe - X X X
1405reqitarpit - X X X
1406reqpass - X X X
1407reqrep - X X X
1408-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1409reqsetbe - X X X
1410reqtarpit - X X X
1411retries X - X X
1412rspadd - X X X
1413rspdel - X X X
1414rspdeny - X X X
1415rspidel - X X X
1416rspideny - X X X
1417rspirep - X X X
1418rsprep - X X X
1419server - - X X
1420source X - X X
1421srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001422stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001423stats auth X - X X
1424stats enable X - X X
1425stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001426stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001427stats realm X - X X
1428stats refresh X - X X
1429stats scope X - X X
1430stats show-desc X - X X
1431stats show-legends X - X X
1432stats show-node X - X X
1433stats uri X - X X
1434-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1435stick match - - X X
1436stick on - - X X
1437stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001438stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001439stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001440tcp-check connect - - X X
1441tcp-check expect - - X X
1442tcp-check send - - X X
1443tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001444tcp-request connection - X X -
1445tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001446tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001447tcp-response content - - X X
1448tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001449timeout check X - X X
1450timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001451timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001452timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1453timeout connect X - X X
1454timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1455timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1456timeout http-request X X X X
1457timeout queue X - X X
1458timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001459timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001460timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1461timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001462timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001463transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001464unique-id-format X X X -
1465unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001466use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001467use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001468------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1469 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001470
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014724.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1473---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001474
1475This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1476
1477
1478acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1479 Declare or complete an access list.
1480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1481 no | yes | yes | yes
1482 Example:
1483 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1484 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1485 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001487 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001488
1489
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001490appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1491 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001492 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1494 no | no | yes | yes
1495 Arguments :
1496 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1497 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1498
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001499 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001500 checked in each cookie value.
1501
1502 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1503 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1504 milliseconds.
1505
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001506 request-learn
1507 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1508 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1509 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1510 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1511 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1512 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1513
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001514 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1515 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1516 data following this prefix.
1517
1518 Example :
1519 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1520
1521 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1522 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1523
1524 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1525 2 modes are currently supported :
1526 - path-parameters :
1527 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1528 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1529 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1530 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1531 - query-string :
1532 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1533 query string.
1534
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001535 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1536 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1537 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1538 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001539 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1540 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1541 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001542 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1543 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1544
1545 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1546
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001547 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1548 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1549 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1550
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001551 Example :
1552 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1553
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001554 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1555 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001556
1557
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001558backlog <conns>
1559 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1561 yes | yes | yes | no
1562 Arguments :
1563 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1564 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001565 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001566
1567 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1568 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1569 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1570 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1571 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1572 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1573 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1574 backlog parameter.
1575
1576 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1577 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1578 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1579
1580 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1581
1582
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001583balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001584balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001585 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1587 yes | no | yes | yes
1588 Arguments :
1589 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1590 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1591 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1592 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1593
1594 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1595 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1596 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1597 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001598 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001599 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001600 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1601 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1602 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1603 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1604 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1605 it, so that you don't worry.
1606
1607 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1608 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1609 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1610 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1611 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1612 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1613 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1614 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001616 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1617 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1618 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1619 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1620 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1621 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1622 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1623 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1624
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001625 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001626 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001627 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1628 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001629 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001630 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1631 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1632 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1633 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1634 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001635 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1636 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1637 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1638 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1639 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1640 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001641
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001642 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1643 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1644 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1645 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1646 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1647 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1648 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1649 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001650 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001651 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001652 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1653 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1654 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001655
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001656 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1657 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1658 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1659 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1660 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1661 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1662 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1663 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1664 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1665 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1666 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1667 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001668
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001669 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001670 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1671 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1672 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1673 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1674 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1675 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1676 URIs start with a leading "/".
1677
1678 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1679 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1680 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1681 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1682
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001683 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001684 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1685
1686 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001687 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1688 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001689 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1690 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1691 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1692 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001693 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001694 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1695 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001696
1697 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1698 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1699 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1700 server will receive the request.
1701
1702 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1703 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1704 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1705 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1706 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001707 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1708 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1709 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001710
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001711 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1712 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1713 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1714 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1715 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001716
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001717 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001718 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1719 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1720 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1721
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001722 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1723 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1724 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1725
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001726 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001727 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001728 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1729 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1730 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1731 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1732 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1733 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001734 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001735 used instead.
1736
1737 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1738 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1739 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1740 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1741
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001742 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1743 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1744 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1745
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001746 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001747
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001748 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001749 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1750 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001751
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001752 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1753 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1754 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001755
1756 Examples :
1757 balance roundrobin
1758 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001759 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001760 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1761 balance hdr(host)
1762 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001763
1764 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1765 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001767 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001768 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1769 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1770 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1771 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1772
1773 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1774 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1775 defaults to 16 kB.
1776
1777 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1778 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1779
1780 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1781 Round Robin.
1782
1783 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1784 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1785 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1786 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1787
1788 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1789
1790 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001791 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001792 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1793 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1794 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001795
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001796 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1797 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001798
1799
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001800bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1801bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001802 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1804 no | yes | yes | no
1805 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001806 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1807 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1808 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1809 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001810 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001811 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1812 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1813 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1814 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1815 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1816 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1817 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaub4fca5d2014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001818 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1819 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1820 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1821 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1822 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1823 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1824 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001825 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1826 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1827 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001828 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1829 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1830 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1831 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001832
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001833 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1834 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001835 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1836 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1837 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001838 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1839 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1840 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1841 the range.
1842
1843 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1844 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1845 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1846 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1847 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1848 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1849 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001850 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001851 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001852
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001853 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1854 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1855 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1856 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1857 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1858 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1859 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1860 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1861
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001862 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1863 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1864 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1865 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001866
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001867 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1868 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1869 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1870 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1871 in a frontend.
1872
1873 Example :
1874 listen http_proxy
1875 bind :80,:443
1876 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001877 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001878
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001879 listen http_https_proxy
1880 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001881 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001882
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001883 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1884 bind ipv6@:80
1885 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1886 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1887
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001888 listen external_bind_app1
1889 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1890
Willy Tarreauf0c95fc2015-09-27 15:03:15 +02001891 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
1892 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
1893 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
1894 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
1895 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
1896
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001897 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001898 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001899
1900
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001901bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001902 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1904 yes | yes | yes | yes
1905 Arguments :
1906 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1907 may be used to override a default value.
1908
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001909 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001910 option may be combined with other numbers.
1911
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001912 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001913 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1914 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1915 missing from all processes.
1916
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001917 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001918 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001919 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1920 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1921 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1922 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001923
1924 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1925 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1926 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1927 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1928 and 'even' instances.
1929
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001930 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1931 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1932 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1933 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001934
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001935 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1936 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1937
Willy Tarreaue56c4f12014-09-16 13:21:03 +02001938 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
1939 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
1940 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
1941
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001942 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1943 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1944
1945 Example :
1946 listen app_ip1
1947 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001948 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001949
1950 listen app_ip2
1951 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001952 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001953
1954 listen management
1955 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001956 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001957
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001958 listen management
1959 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1960 bind-process 1-4
1961
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001962 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001963
1964
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001965block { if | unless } <condition>
1966 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1968 no | yes | yes | yes
1969
1970 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1971 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001972 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001973 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001974 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1975 "block" statements per instance.
1976
1977 Example:
1978 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1979 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1980 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1981 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1982
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001983 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001984
1985
1986capture cookie <name> len <length>
1987 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1989 no | yes | yes | no
1990 Arguments :
1991 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1992 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1993 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1994 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1995 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1996
1997 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1998 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1999 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2000 right if it exceeds <length>.
2001
2002 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2003 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2004 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2005 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2006
2007 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2008 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2009 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2010
2011 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2012 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2013 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002014 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2015 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2016 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017
2018 Example:
2019 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2020
2021 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002022 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002023
2024
2025capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002026 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2028 no | yes | yes | no
2029 Arguments :
2030 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002031 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002032 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2033 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2034 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2035
2036 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2037 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2038 it exceeds <length>.
2039
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002040 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002041 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2042 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002043 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2044 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2045 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2046 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002047 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002048 environments to find where the request came from.
2049
2050 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2051 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2052 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2053 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002055 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2056 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2057 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2058 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2059 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060
2061 Example:
2062 capture request header Host len 15
2063 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2064 capture request header Referrer len 15
2065
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002066 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002067 about logging.
2068
2069
2070capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002071 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2073 no | yes | yes | no
2074 Arguments :
2075 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002076 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002077 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2078 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2079 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2080
2081 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2082 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2083 it exceeds <length>.
2084
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002085 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2087 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2088 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002089 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2090 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2091 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2092 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002093
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002094 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2095 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2096 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2097 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2098 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002099
2100 Example:
2101 capture response header Content-length len 9
2102 capture response header Location len 15
2103
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002104 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002105 about logging.
2106
2107
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002108clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002109 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2111 yes | yes | yes | no
2112 Arguments :
2113 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2114 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2115 as explained at the top of this document.
2116
2117 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2118 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2119 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2120 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2121 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2122 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2123 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2124 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002125 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002126 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2127 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2128
2129 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2130 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2131 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2132 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2133 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2134 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2135
2136 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2137 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2138
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002139 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2140 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002141
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002142compression algo <algorithm> ...
2143compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002144compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002145 Enable HTTP compression.
2146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2147 yes | yes | yes | yes
2148 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002149 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2150 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2151 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2152
2153 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002154 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002155 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2156 data.
2157
2158 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2159 support for zlib was built in.
2160
2161 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2162 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2163 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2164 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2165 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2166 in.
2167
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002168 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002169 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002170 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2171 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2172 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2173 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2174 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002175
2176 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2177 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2178 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2179 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2180 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002181 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2182 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2183 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2184 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2185 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreau4cf57af2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002186 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2187 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002188
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002189 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002190 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2191 "Accept-Encoding" header
2192 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002193 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002194 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2195 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002196 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2197 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2198 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2199 "multipart"
2200 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2201 header
2202 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2203 and later
2204 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2205 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002206
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002207 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2208 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002209
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002210 Examples :
2211 compression algo gzip
2212 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002213
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002214contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002215 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2217 yes | no | yes | yes
2218 Arguments :
2219 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2220 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2221 as explained at the top of this document.
2222
2223 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002224 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002225 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002226 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2227 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2228 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2229 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2230
2231 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2232 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2233 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2234 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2235 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2236 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2237
2238 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2239 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2240 instead.
2241
2242 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2243 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2244
2245
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002246cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002247 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2248 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002249 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2251 yes | no | yes | yes
2252 Arguments :
2253 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2254 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2255 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2256 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2257 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2258 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2259 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2260 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2261 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2262
2263 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2264 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2265 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2266 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2267 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2268 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2269 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2270 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2271 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2272 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2273 "insert" and "prefix".
2274
2275 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002276 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002277
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002278 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002279 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2280 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2281 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2282 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2283 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2284 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2285 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2286 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2287 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2288 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002289
2290 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2291 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2292 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2293 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2294 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2295 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2296 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2297 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2298 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2299 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002300 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2301 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2302 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002303
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002304 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2305 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2306 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002307 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2308 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2309 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2310 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002311 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2312 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2313 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002314
2315 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2316 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2317 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2318 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2319 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2320 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2321 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2322 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2323 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2324
2325 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2326 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2327 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2328 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2329 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2330 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2331 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2332 persistence cookie in the cache.
2333 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2334
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002335 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2336 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2337 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2338 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2339 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2340 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2341 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2342 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2343 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2344 they logout.
2345
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002346 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2347 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2348 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2349 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2350
2351 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2352 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2353 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2354 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2355 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2356 this attribute.
2357
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002358 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002359 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002360 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2361 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2362 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2363 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2364 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2365 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002366
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002367 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2368 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2369 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2370 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2371 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2372 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2373 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2374 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2375 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2376 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2377 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2378 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2379 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2380 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2381 the site.
2382
2383 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2384 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2385 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2386 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2387 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2388 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2389 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2390 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2391 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2392 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2393 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2394 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2395 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2396 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2397 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2398 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2399
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002400 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2401 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2402 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2403 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002404
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002405 Examples :
2406 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2407 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2408 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002409 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002410
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002411 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002412 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002413
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002414
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002415default-server [param*]
2416 Change default options for a server in a backend
2417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2418 yes | no | yes | yes
2419 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002420 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2421 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2422 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2423 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002424
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002425 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002426 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2427
2428 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002429
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002430
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002431default_backend <backend>
2432 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2434 yes | yes | yes | no
2435 Arguments :
2436 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2437
2438 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2439 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2440 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2441 will catch all undetermined requests.
2442
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002443 Example :
2444
2445 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2446 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2447 default_backend dynamic
2448
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002449 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2450
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002451
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002452description <string>
2453 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2455 no | yes | yes | yes
2456 Arguments : string
2457
2458 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2459 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2460 it describes.
2461 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2462
2463
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002464disabled
2465 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2467 yes | yes | yes | yes
2468 Arguments : none
2469
2470 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2471 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2472 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2473 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2474 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2475 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2476 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2477
2478 See also : "enabled"
2479
2480
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002481dispatch <address>:<port>
2482 Set a default server address
2483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2484 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002485 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002486
2487 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2488 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2489 during start-up.
2490
2491 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2492 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2493 possible with normal servers.
2494
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002495 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002496 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2497 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2498 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2499 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2500
2501 See also : "server"
2502
2503
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002504enabled
2505 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2507 yes | yes | yes | yes
2508 Arguments : none
2509
2510 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2511 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2512
2513 See also : "disabled"
2514
2515
2516errorfile <code> <file>
2517 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2519 yes | yes | yes | yes
2520 Arguments :
2521 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002522 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002523
2524 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002525 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002526 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002527 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2528 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002529
2530 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2531 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2532 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2533
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002534 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2535
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002536 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2537 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2538 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2539 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2540
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002541 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2542 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2543 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2544 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2545 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2546 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2547
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002548 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2549 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2550 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002551 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002552 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2553
2554 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2555
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002556 Example :
2557 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002558 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002559 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2560 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2561
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002562
2563errorloc <code> <url>
2564errorloc302 <code> <url>
2565 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2567 yes | yes | yes | yes
2568 Arguments :
2569 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002570 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002571
2572 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2573 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2574 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2575 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2576 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2577
2578 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2579 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2580 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2581
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002582 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2583
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002584 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2585 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2586 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2587 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2588 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2589 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2590 request.
2591
2592 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2593
2594
2595errorloc303 <code> <url>
2596 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2598 yes | yes | yes | yes
2599 Arguments :
2600 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2601 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2602
2603 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2604 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2605 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2606 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2607 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2608
2609 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2610 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2611 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2612
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002613 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2614
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002615 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2616 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2617 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2618 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002619 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002620
2621 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2622
2623
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002624force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2625 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2626 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2627 no | yes | yes | yes
2628
2629 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2630 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2631 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2632 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2633 marked down for maintenance operations.
2634
2635 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2636 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2637 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2638 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2639 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2640 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2641 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2642 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2643 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2644
2645 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2646 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2647 is used.
2648
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002649 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002650 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002651
2652
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002653fullconn <conns>
2654 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2656 yes | no | yes | yes
2657 Arguments :
2658 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2659 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2660
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002661 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002662 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002663 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002664 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2665 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2666 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2667 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2668 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002669 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002670
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002671 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2672 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002673 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2674 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2675 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002676
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002677 Example :
2678 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2679 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2680 # connections.
2681 backend dynamic
2682 fullconn 10000
2683 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2684 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2685
2686 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2687
2688
2689grace <time>
2690 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002692 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002693 Arguments :
2694 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2695 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2696 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2697
2698 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2699 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002700 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002701 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2702
2703 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2704 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2705 simplify it.
2706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002708hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002709 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2711 yes | no | yes | yes
2712 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002713 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2714 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002715
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002716 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2717 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2718 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2719 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2720 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2721 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2722 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2723 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2724 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2725 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002726
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002727 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2728 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2729 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2730 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2731 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2732 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2733 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2734 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2735 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2736 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2737 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2738 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2739 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002740 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2741 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002742
2743 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2744
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002745 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002746 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2747 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2748 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002749 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2750 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2751 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002752
2753 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2754 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002755 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2756 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2757 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2758 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2759
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002760 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2761 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2762 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2763 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2764 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2765 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2766 parameter.
2767
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002768 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2769
2770 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2771 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2772 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2773 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2774 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2775 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2776 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2777 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2778 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2779 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2780 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2781 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002782
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002783 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2784 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2785 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002786
2787 See also : "balance", "server"
2788
2789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002790http-check disable-on-404
2791 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002793 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002794 Arguments : none
2795
2796 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2797 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2798 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2799 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2800 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2801 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2802 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2803 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002804 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2805 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2806 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2807
2808 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2809
2810
2811http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002812 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002814 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002815 Arguments :
2816 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2817 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002818 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002819 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2820 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2821 details on the supported keywords.
2822
2823 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2824 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2825 with the usual backslash ('\').
2826
2827 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2828 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2829 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2830 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2831 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2832
2833 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002834 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002835 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2836 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2837 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2838
2839 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002840 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002841 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2842 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2843 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2844 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2845
2846 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002847 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002848 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2849 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2850 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2851 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2852 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2853 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2854 trace).
2855
2856 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002857 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002858 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2859 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2860 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2861 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2862 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2863 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2864
2865 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2866 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2867 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2868 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2869 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2870 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2871 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2872 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2873
Cyril Bontéa448e162015-01-30 00:07:07 +01002874 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
2875 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
2876 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
2877
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002878 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2879 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2880
2881 Examples :
2882 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002883 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002884
2885 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002886 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002887
2888 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002889 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002890
2891 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002892 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002893
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002894 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002895
2896
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002897http-check send-state
2898 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2900 yes | no | yes | yes
2901 Arguments : none
2902
2903 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2904 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2905 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2906 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2907 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2908
2909 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2910 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2911 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2912 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2913 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2914 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2915 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2916 checked in multiple backends.
2917
2918 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2919 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2920
2921 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2922 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2923 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2924 one fails.
2925
2926 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2927 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2928 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2929
2930 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2931 server's queue.
2932
2933 Example of a header received by the application server :
2934 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2935 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2936
2937 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2938
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002939http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002940 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002941 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002942 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2943 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002944 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2945 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2946 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2947 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2948 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2949 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002950 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002951 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2952
2953 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2954 no | yes | yes | yes
2955
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002956 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2957 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2958 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2959 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2960 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002961
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002962 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2963 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2964 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2965
2966 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2967 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2968 are evaluated.
2969
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002970 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2971 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2972 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2973 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2974 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2975 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2976 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2977 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2978 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002979 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002980 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2981
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002982 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2983 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2984 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2985 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2986 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2987
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002988 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2989 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2990 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002991 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2992 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002993
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002994 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2995 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2996 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2997 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2998 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2999 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3000 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3001 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3002
3003 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3004 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3005 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreaufcf75d22015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003006 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3007 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003008
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003009 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3010 <name>.
3011
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003012 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3013 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3014 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3015 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3016 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3017 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3018 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3019 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3020
3021 Example:
3022
3023 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3024
3025 applied to:
3026
3027 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3028
3029 outputs:
3030
3031 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3032
3033 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3034
3035 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3036 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3037 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3038 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3039 header.
3040
3041 Example:
3042
3043 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3044
3045 applied to:
3046
3047 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3048
3049 outputs:
3050
3051 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3052
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003053 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3054 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3055 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3056 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3057 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3058 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3059 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3060 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3061
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003062 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3063 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3064 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3065 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3066 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3067 another equipment.
3068
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003069 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3070 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3071 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3072 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3073 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3074 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3075 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3076 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3077
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003078 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3079 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3080 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3081 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3082 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3083 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3084 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3085 admin privileges.
3086
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003087 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3088 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3089 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3090 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3091 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3092 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3093 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3094 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3095
3096 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3097 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3098 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3099 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3100 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3101 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3102
3103 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3104 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3105 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3106 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3107 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3108 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3109
3110 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3111 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3112 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3113 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3114 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3115 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3116 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3117 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3118 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3119
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003120 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3121
3122 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3123 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3124 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3125 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003126
3127 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003128 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3129 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3130 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003131
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003132 http-request allow if nagios
3133 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3134 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3135 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003136
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003137 Example:
3138 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003139 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003140
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003141 Example:
3142 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3143 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaud3a93a92015-08-27 17:15:05 +02003144 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003145 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3146 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3147 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3148 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3149 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3150 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3151
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003152 Example:
3153 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3154 acl add path /addacl
3155 acl del path /delacl
3156
3157 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3158
3159 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3160 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3161
3162 Example:
3163 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3164 acl setmap path /setmap
3165 acl delmap path /delmap
3166
3167 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3168
3169 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3170 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3171
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003172 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3173 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003174
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003175http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003176 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003177 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3178 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003179 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3180 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3181 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3182 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3183 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3184 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003185 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003186 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3187
3188 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3189 no | yes | yes | yes
3190
3191 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3192 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3193 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3194 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3195 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3196 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3197
3198 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3199 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3200 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3201 current section.
3202
3203 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3204 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3205 rules are evaluated.
3206
3207 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3208 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3209 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3210 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3211 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3212 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3213 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3214
3215 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3216 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3217 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3218 external users.
3219
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003220 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3221 <name>.
3222
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003223 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3224 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3225 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3226 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3227 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3228 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3229 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3230 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3231
3232 Example:
3233
3234 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3235
3236 applied to:
3237
3238 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3239
3240 outputs:
3241
3242 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3243
3244 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3245
3246 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3247 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3248 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3249 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3250 header.
3251
3252 Example:
3253
3254 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3255
3256 applied to:
3257
3258 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3259
3260 outputs:
3261
3262 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3263
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003264 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3265 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3266 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3267 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3268 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3269 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3270 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3271 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3272
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003273 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3274 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3275 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3276 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3277 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3278 another equipment.
3279
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003280 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3281 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3282 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3283 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3284 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3285 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3286 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3287 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3288
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003289 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3290 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3291 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3292 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3293 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3294 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3295 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3296 admin privileges.
3297
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003298 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3299 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3300 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3301 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3302 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3303 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3304 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3305 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3306
3307 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3308 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3309 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3310 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3311 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3312 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3313
3314 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3315 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3316 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3317 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3318 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3319 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3320
3321 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3322 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3323 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3324 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3325 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3326 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3327 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3328 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3329 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3330
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003331 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3332
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003333 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003334 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3335 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3336 rules.
3337
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003338 Example:
3339 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3340
3341 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3342
3343 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3344 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3345
3346 Example:
3347 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3348
3349 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3350
3351 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3352 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3353
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003354 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3355 ACL usage.
3356
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003357
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003358http-send-name-header [<header>]
3359 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3360
3361 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3362 yes | no | yes | yes
3363
3364 Arguments :
3365
3366 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3367
3368 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3369 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3370 is added with the header string proved.
3371
3372 See also : "server"
3373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003374id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003375 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3377 no | yes | yes | yes
3378 Arguments : none
3379
3380 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3381 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3382 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003383
3384
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003385ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3386 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3387 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3388 no | yes | yes | yes
3389
3390 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3391 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3392 and running).
3393
3394 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3395 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3396 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003397 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003398 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3399
3400 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3401 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3402
3403 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3404 "unless" condition is met.
3405
3406 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3407
3408
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003409log global
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003410log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003411no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003412 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3414 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003415
3416 Prefix :
3417 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3418 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3419 prefix does not allow arguments.
3420
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003421 Arguments :
3422 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3423 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3424 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3425 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3426 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3427 parameter.
3428
3429 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3430 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3431
3432 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3433 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3434 standard syslog port).
3435
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003436 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3437 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3438 standard syslog port).
3439
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003440 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3441 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3442 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3443 appropriately writeable).
3444
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003445 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3446 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3447 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3448 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3449
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003450 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3451 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3452 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3453 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3454 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3455 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3456 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3457 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3458 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3459 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3460 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3461
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003462 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3463
3464 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3465 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3466 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3467
3468 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3469 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3470 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003471 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3472 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3473 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3474 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3475 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003476
3477 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3478
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003479 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3480 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3481 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003482
3483 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3484 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3485 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3486 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3487
3488 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3489 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003490
3491 Example :
3492 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003493 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3494 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003495 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3496
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003497
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003498log-format <string>
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003499 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3500 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3501 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003502
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003503 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3504 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3505 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3506 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3507 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003508
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003509
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003510max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3511 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3512 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3513 yes | no | yes | yes
3514
3515 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3516 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3517 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3518 servers.
3519
3520 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3521 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3522 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3523 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3524 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3525 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3526 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3527 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3528 picking a different server.
3529
3530 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3531 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3532 even if they have to be queued.
3533
3534 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3535 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3536
3537
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003538maxconn <conns>
3539 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3541 yes | yes | yes | no
3542 Arguments :
3543 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3544 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3545 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3546 closes.
3547
3548 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3549 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3550 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3551 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3552 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3553 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3554 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3555 properly tuned.
3556
3557 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3558 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3559 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3560
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003561 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3562
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003563 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3564
3565
3566mode { tcp|http|health }
3567 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3569 yes | yes | yes | yes
3570 Arguments :
3571 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3572 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3573 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3574 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3575
3576 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3577 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3578 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3579 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3580 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3581
3582 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003583 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3584 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3585 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3586 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3587 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3588 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3589 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003590
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003591 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3592 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3593 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003594
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003595 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003596 defaults http_instances
3597 mode http
3598
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003599 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003600
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003601
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003602monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003603 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3605 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003606 Arguments :
3607 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3608 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003609 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003610 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3611 backend and its backup.
3612
3613 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3614 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3615 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3616 servers in a list of backends.
3617
3618 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3619 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3620 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3621 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3622 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3623 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3624 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003625 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3626 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003627
3628 Example:
3629 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003630 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003631 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3632 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3633 monitor-uri /site_alive
3634 monitor fail if site_dead
3635
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003636 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003637
3638
3639monitor-net <source>
3640 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3642 yes | yes | yes | no
3643 Arguments :
3644 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3645 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3646 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3647 followed by a mask.
3648
3649 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3650 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003651 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003652 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3653
3654 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3655 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3656 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3657 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003658 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3659 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3660 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003661
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003662 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3663 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3664 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3665 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3666 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3667 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003668
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003669 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3670 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003671
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003672 Example :
3673 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3674 frontend www
3675 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3676
3677 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3678
3679
3680monitor-uri <uri>
3681 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3683 yes | yes | yes | no
3684 Arguments :
3685 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3686 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3687
3688 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3689 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3690 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3691 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3692 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3693 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3694 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3695 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3696
3697 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3698 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3699 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3700 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3701 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3702 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3703
3704 Example :
3705 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3706 frontend www
3707 mode http
3708 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3709
3710 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3711
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003712
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003713option abortonclose
3714no option abortonclose
3715 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3717 yes | no | yes | yes
3718 Arguments : none
3719
3720 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3721 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3722 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3723 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003724 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003725 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3726 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3727 encountered while delivering the response.
3728
3729 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3730 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3731 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3732 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3733 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3734 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003735 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003736 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003737 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003738 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3739 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3740 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3741
3742 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3743 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3744 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3745 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3746 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3747 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3748 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3749 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003750 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003751
3752 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3753 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3754
3755 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3756
3757
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003758option accept-invalid-http-request
3759no option accept-invalid-http-request
3760 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3762 yes | yes | yes | no
3763 Arguments : none
3764
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003765 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003766 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3767 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3768 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3769 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3770 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3771 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3772 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003773 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3774 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3775 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3776 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3777 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003778 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
3779 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple
3780 digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003781
3782 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3783 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3784 been confirmed.
3785
3786 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3787 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003788 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3789 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003790 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3791
3792 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3793 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3794
3795 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3796 stats socket.
3797
3798
3799option accept-invalid-http-response
3800no option accept-invalid-http-response
3801 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3803 yes | no | yes | yes
3804 Arguments : none
3805
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003806 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003807 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3808 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3809 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3810 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3811 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3812 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3813 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003814 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
3815 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
3816 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003817
3818 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3819 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3820 been confirmed.
3821
3822 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3823 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3824 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3825 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3826
3827 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3828 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3829
3830 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3831 stats socket.
3832
3833
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003834option allbackups
3835no option allbackups
3836 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3838 yes | no | yes | yes
3839 Arguments : none
3840
3841 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3842 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3843 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3844 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3845 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3846 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3847 order between the backup servers anymore.
3848
3849 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3850 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3851
3852 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3853 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3854
3855
3856option checkcache
3857no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003858 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3860 yes | no | yes | yes
3861 Arguments : none
3862
3863 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3864 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003865 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003866 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3867 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003868 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003869
3870 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003871 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003872 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003873 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3874 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003875 to the client are :
3876 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003877 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003878 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003879 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3880 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3881 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3882 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3883 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3884 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3885 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3886 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3887 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3888 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3889 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3890
3891 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003892 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003893 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003894 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003895 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3896
3897 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3898 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003899 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003900 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3901
3902 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3903 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3904
3905
3906option clitcpka
3907no option clitcpka
3908 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3910 yes | yes | yes | no
3911 Arguments : none
3912
3913 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3914 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3915 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3916 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3917
3918 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3919 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3920 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3921 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3922
3923 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3924 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3925 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3926 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3927 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3928
3929 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3930
3931 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3932 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3933 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3934
3935 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3936 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3937
3938 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3939
3940
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003941option contstats
3942 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3944 yes | yes | yes | no
3945 Arguments : none
3946
3947 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3948 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3949 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3950 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3951 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3952 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3953 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3954
3955
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003956option dontlog-normal
3957no option dontlog-normal
3958 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3960 yes | yes | yes | no
3961 Arguments : none
3962
3963 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3964 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3965 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3966 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3967 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3968 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3969 logged.
3970
3971 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3972 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3973 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3974
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003975 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003976 logging.
3977
3978
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003979option dontlognull
3980no option dontlognull
3981 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3983 yes | yes | yes | no
3984 Arguments : none
3985
3986 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3987 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3988 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3989 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3990 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3991 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02003992 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
3993 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
3994 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003995
3996 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3997 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3998 would not be logged.
3999
4000 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4001 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4002
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004003 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4004 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004005
4006
4007option forceclose
4008no option forceclose
4009 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004011 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004012 Arguments : none
4013
4014 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4015 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4016 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4017 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4018 global session times in the logs.
4019
4020 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004021 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004022 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004023
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004024 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4025 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4026 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4027
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004028 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4029 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004030
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004031 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4032 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4033
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004034 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004035
4036
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004037option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004038 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4040 yes | yes | yes | yes
4041 Arguments :
4042 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4043 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004044 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004045 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004046
4047 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4048 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4049 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4050 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4051 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4052 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4053 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004054 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4055 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4056 possible that the client has already brought one.
4057
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004058 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004059 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004060 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4061 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004062 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4063 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004064
4065 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4066 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4067 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4068 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4069 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4070 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4071 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4072
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004073 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4074 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4075 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4076 are under the control of the end-user.
4077
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004078 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004079 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4080 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004081 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4082 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4083 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004084
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004085 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004086 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4087 frontend www
4088 mode http
4089 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4090
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004091 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4092 backend www
4093 mode http
4094 option forwardfor header X-Client
4095
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004096 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004097 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004098
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004099
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004100option http-ignore-probes
4101no option http-ignore-probes
4102 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4104 yes | yes | yes | no
4105 Arguments : none
4106
4107 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4108 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4109 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4110 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4111 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4112 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4113 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4114 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4115 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4116 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4117 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4118 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4119
4120 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4121 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4122 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4123 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4124 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4125 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4126 are often the only way to detect them.
4127
4128 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4129 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4130
4131 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4132
4133
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004134option http-keep-alive
4135no option http-keep-alive
4136 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4138 yes | yes | yes | yes
4139 Arguments : none
4140
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004141 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4142 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4143 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4144 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4145 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4146 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4147 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4148
4149 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4150 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004151 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4152 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4153 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4154 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4155 situations where this option may be useful :
4156
4157 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4158 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4159
4160 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4161 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4162
4163 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4164 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4165 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4166 request.
4167
4168 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4169 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004170 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4171 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4172 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004173
4174 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4175 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4176
4177 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4178 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4179 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4180 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4181 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4182 not set.
4183
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004184 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4185 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004186 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004187 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004188
4189 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004190 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4191 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004192
4193
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004194option http-no-delay
4195no option http-no-delay
4196 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4198 yes | yes | yes | yes
4199 Arguments : none
4200
4201 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4202 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4203 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4204 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4205 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4206 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4207 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4208 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4209 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4210 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4211 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4212 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4213 affected.
4214
4215 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4216 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4217 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4218 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4219 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4220 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4221 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4222 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4223 latency environments.
4224
4225
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004226option http-pretend-keepalive
4227no option http-pretend-keepalive
4228 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4230 yes | yes | yes | yes
4231 Arguments : none
4232
4233 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4234 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4235 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4236 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4237 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4238 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4239 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4240 consider the response complete.
4241
4242 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4243 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4244 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4245 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4246 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4247 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4248
4249 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4250 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4251 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4252 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4253 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4254 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4255 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4256
4257 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4258 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004259 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004260 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4261 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004262
4263 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4264 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4265
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004266 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4267 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004268
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004269
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004270option http-server-close
4271no option http-server-close
4272 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4274 yes | yes | yes | yes
4275 Arguments : none
4276
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004277 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4278 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4279 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4280 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4281 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4282 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4283 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4284 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4285 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4286 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4287 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4288 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4289 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4290 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4291 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4292 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004293
4294 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4295 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4296 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4297 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004298 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4299 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004300
4301 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4302 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004303 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4304 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004305 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4306 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004307
4308 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4309 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4310
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004311 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004312 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4313 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004314
4315
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004316option http-tunnel
4317no option http-tunnel
4318 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4320 yes | yes | yes | yes
4321 Arguments : none
4322
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004323 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4324 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4325 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4326 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4327 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4328 "option http-tunnel".
4329
4330 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004331 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004332 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4333 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4334 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4335 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4336 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4337 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4338 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004339
4340 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4341 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4342
4343 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4344 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4345 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4346
4347
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004348option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004349no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004350 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4352 yes | yes | yes | no
4353 Arguments : none
4354
4355 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4356 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4357 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4358 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4359 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4360 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4361 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4362
4363 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4364 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4365 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4366 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4367 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4368 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4369 request along its whole life.
4370
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004371 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4372 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4373 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4374 front of an existing proxy.
4375
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004376 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4377
4378 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4379 http-server-close".
4380
4381
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004382option httpchk
4383option httpchk <uri>
4384option httpchk <method> <uri>
4385option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4386 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4388 yes | no | yes | yes
4389 Arguments :
4390 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4391 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4392 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4393 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4394 ones.
4395
4396 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4397 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4398 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4399
4400 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4401 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4402 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4403 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4404 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4405
4406 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4407 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4408 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4409 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4410 the lack of any response.
4411
4412 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4413
4414 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4415 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4416 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4417
4418 Examples :
4419 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4420 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4421 backend https_relay
4422 mode tcp
4423 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4424 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4425
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004426 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4427 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4428 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004429
4430
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004431option httpclose
4432no option httpclose
4433 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4435 yes | yes | yes | yes
4436 Arguments : none
4437
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004438 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4439 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4440 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4441 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004442 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004443 "option http-tunnel".
4444
4445 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4446 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4447 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4448 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4449 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4450 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4451 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4452 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004453
4454 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004455 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004456 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4457 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4458 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4459 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4460 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004461
4462 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4463 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004464 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4465 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004466 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4467 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004468
4469 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4470 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4471
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004472 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4473 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004474
4475
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004476option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004477 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4479 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004480 Arguments :
4481 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4482 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4483 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4484 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4485 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004486
4487 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4488 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4489 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4490 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4491 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4492 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4493 ports.
4494
4495 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4496
PiBa-NL211c2e92014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004497 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4498 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004500 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004501
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004502
4503option http_proxy
4504no option http_proxy
4505 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4507 yes | yes | yes | yes
4508 Arguments : none
4509
4510 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4511 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4512 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4513 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4514 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4515
4516 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4517 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4518 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4519 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004520 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004521 be analyzed.
4522
4523 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4524 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4525
4526 Example :
4527 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4528 backend direct_forward
4529 option httpclose
4530 option http_proxy
4531
4532 See also : "option httpclose"
4533
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004534
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004535option independent-streams
4536no option independent-streams
4537 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4539 yes | yes | yes | yes
4540 Arguments : none
4541
4542 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4543 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4544 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4545 receive data or not.
4546
4547 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4548 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4549 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4550 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4551 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4552 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4553 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4554 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4555 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4556 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4557 socket buffers.
4558
4559 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4560 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4561 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4562 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4563 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4564
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004565 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004566 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4567 deprecated.
4568
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004569 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004570
4571
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004572option ldap-check
4573 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4575 yes | no | yes | yes
4576 Arguments : none
4577
4578 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4579 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4580 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4581 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4582
4583 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4584 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4585
4586 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4587 configure it.
4588
4589 Example :
4590 option ldap-check
4591
4592 See also : "option httpchk"
4593
4594
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004595option log-health-checks
4596no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004597 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4599 yes | no | yes | yes
4600 Arguments : none
4601
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004602 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4603 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4604 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004605
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004606 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4607 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4608 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4609 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4610 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4611
4612 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4613 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004614
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004615 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4616 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4617 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004618
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004619
4620option log-separate-errors
4621no option log-separate-errors
4622 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4624 yes | yes | yes | no
4625 Arguments : none
4626
4627 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4628 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4629 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4630 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4631 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4632 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4633 provides very important information.
4634
4635 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4636 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4637 error logs.
4638
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004639 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004640 logging.
4641
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004642
4643option logasap
4644no option logasap
4645 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4647 yes | yes | yes | no
4648 Arguments : none
4649
4650 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4651 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4652 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4653 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4654 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4655 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4656 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004657 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004658 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4659 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4660
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004661 Examples :
4662 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4663 mode http
4664 option httplog
4665 option logasap
4666 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4667
4668 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4669 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4670 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4671 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004673 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004674 logging.
4675
4676
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004677option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004678 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4680 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004681 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004682 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4683 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004684 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004685
4686 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4687 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4688 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4689 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4690 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4691 in the MySQL table, like this :
4692
4693 USE mysql;
4694 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4695 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4696
4697 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4698 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4699 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4700 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4701 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4702 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4703 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4704 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4705 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4706
4707 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4708 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004709
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004710 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004711
4712 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4713 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4714 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4715 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4716 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4717 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4718
4719 See also: "option httpchk"
4720
4721
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004722option nolinger
4723no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004724 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004725 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4726 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004727 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004728
4729 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4730 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4731 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4732 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4733 connections.
4734
4735 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4736 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4737 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4738 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4739 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4740 this too.
4741
4742 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4743 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4744 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4745
4746 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4747 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4748 for servers.
4749
4750 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4751 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4752
4753
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004754option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4755 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4757 yes | yes | yes | yes
4758 Arguments :
4759 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4760 matching <network>
4761 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4762 header name.
4763
4764 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4765 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4766 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4767 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4768 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4769 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4770 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4771 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4772 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4773 possible that the client has already brought one.
4774
4775 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4776 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4777 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4778 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4779 header and requires different one.
4780
4781 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4782 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4783 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4784 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4785 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4786 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4787 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4788
4789 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4790 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4791 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4792 both are defined.
4793
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004794 Examples :
4795 # Original Destination address
4796 frontend www
4797 mode http
4798 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4799
4800 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4801 backend www
4802 mode http
4803 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4804
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004805 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4806 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004807
4808
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004809option persist
4810no option persist
4811 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4812 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4813 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004814 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004815
4816 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4817 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4818 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4819 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4820 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4821 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4822 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4823 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4824 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4825 redirected to another valid server.
4826
4827 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4828 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4829
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004830 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004831
4832
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004833option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4834 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4836 yes | no | yes | yes
4837 Arguments :
4838 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4839 PostgreSQL server.
4840
4841 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4842 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4843 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4844 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4845
4846 See also: "option httpchk"
4847
4848
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004849option prefer-last-server
4850no option prefer-last-server
4851 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4852 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4853 yes | no | yes | yes
4854 Arguments : none
4855
4856 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4857 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4858 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4859 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4860 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4861 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4862 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4863 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4864 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004865 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4866 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4867 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4868 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4869 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4870 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4871 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004872
4873 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4874 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4875
4876 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4877
4878
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004879option redispatch
4880no option redispatch
4881 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4882 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4883 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004884 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004885
4886 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4887 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4888 be able to access the service anymore.
4889
4890 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4891 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4892
4893 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4894 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4895 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004896
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004897 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4898 "redisp" keywords.
4899
4900 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4901 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4902
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004903 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004904
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004905
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004906option redis-check
4907 Use redis health checks for server testing
4908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4909 yes | no | yes | yes
4910 Arguments : none
4911
4912 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4913 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4914 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4915 find the "+PONG" response message.
4916
4917 Example :
4918 option redis-check
4919
4920 See also : "option httpchk"
4921
4922
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004923option smtpchk
4924option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4925 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4927 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004928 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004929 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4930 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4931 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4932
4933 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4934 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4935 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4936
4937 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4938 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4939 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4940 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4941 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4942 dead server.
4943
4944 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4945 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4946 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4947 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4948
4949 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4950 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4951 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4952 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4953 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4954
4955 Example :
4956 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4957
4958 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4959
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004960
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004961option socket-stats
4962no option socket-stats
4963
4964 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4966 yes | yes | yes | no
4967
4968 Arguments : none
4969
4970
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004971option splice-auto
4972no option splice-auto
4973 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4975 yes | yes | yes | yes
4976 Arguments : none
4977
4978 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4979 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4980 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4981 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004982 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004983 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4984 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4985 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4986 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4987
4988 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4989 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4990 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4991 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4992 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4993 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4994 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4995 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4996 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4997 keyword.
4998
4999 Example :
5000 option splice-auto
5001
5002 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5003 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5004
5005 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5006 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5007
5008
5009option splice-request
5010no option splice-request
5011 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5013 yes | yes | yes | yes
5014 Arguments : none
5015
5016 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005017 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005018 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5019 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5020 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5021 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5022
5023 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5024
5025 Example :
5026 option splice-request
5027
5028 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5029 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5030
5031 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5032 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5033
5034
5035option splice-response
5036no option splice-response
5037 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5039 yes | yes | yes | yes
5040 Arguments : none
5041
5042 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005043 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005044 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5045 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5046 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5047 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5048
5049 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5050
5051 Example :
5052 option splice-response
5053
5054 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5055 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5056
5057 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5058 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5059
5060
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005061option srvtcpka
5062no option srvtcpka
5063 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5065 yes | no | yes | yes
5066 Arguments : none
5067
5068 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5069 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5070 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5071 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5072
5073 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5074 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5075 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5076 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5077
5078 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5079 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5080 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5081 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5082 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5083
5084 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5085
5086 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5087 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5088 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5089
5090 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5091 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5092
5093 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5094
5095
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005096option ssl-hello-chk
5097 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5099 yes | no | yes | yes
5100 Arguments : none
5101
5102 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5103 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5104 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5105 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5106 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5107 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5108 hello message.
5109
5110 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5111 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5112 messages, which is appreciable.
5113
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005114 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5115 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5116 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005117
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005118 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5119
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005120
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005121option tcp-check
5122 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5123 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5124 yes | no | yes | yes
5125
5126 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5127 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5128
5129 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5130 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5131 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5132
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005133 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005134 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5135 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5136 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5137 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5138 only.
5139
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005140 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005141 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5142 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5143 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5144 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5145
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005146 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005147 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5148 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005149 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005150 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5151 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5152 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5153 the respective protocols.
5154 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5155 analysed.
5156
5157 Examples :
5158 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5159 option tcp-check
5160 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5161
5162 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5163 option tcp-check
5164 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5165
5166 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5167 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005168 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005169 option tcp-check
5170 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5171 tcp-check expect +PONG
5172 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5173 tcp-check expect string role:master
5174 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5175 tcp-check expect string +OK
5176
5177 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5178 (send many headers before analyzing)
5179 option tcp-check
5180 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5181 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5182 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5183 tcp-check send \r\n
5184 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5185
5186
5187 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5188
5189
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005190option tcp-smart-accept
5191no option tcp-smart-accept
5192 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5194 yes | yes | yes | no
5195 Arguments : none
5196
5197 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5198 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5199 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5200 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5201 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5202 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5203
5204 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5205 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5206 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5207 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5208
5209 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5210 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5211 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5212 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5213
5214 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5215 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5216 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5217
5218 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5219 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5220 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5221
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005222 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5223
5224
5225option tcp-smart-connect
5226no option tcp-smart-connect
5227 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5229 yes | no | yes | yes
5230 Arguments : none
5231
5232 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5233 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5234 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5235 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5236 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5237
5238 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5239 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5240 complex.
5241
5242 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5243 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5244 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5245
5246 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5247 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5248
5249 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5250
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005251
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005252option tcpka
5253 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5255 yes | yes | yes | yes
5256 Arguments : none
5257
5258 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5259 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5260 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5261 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5262
5263 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5264 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5265 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5266 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5267
5268 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5269 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5270 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5271 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5272 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5273
5274 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5275
5276 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5277 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5278 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5279 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5280 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5281 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5282 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5283 backends.
5284
5285 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5286
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005287
5288option tcplog
5289 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5291 yes | yes | yes | yes
5292 Arguments : none
5293
5294 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5295 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5296 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5297 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5298 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5299 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5300 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5301 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5302
5303 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005305 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005306
5307
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005308option transparent
5309no option transparent
5310 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005312 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005313 Arguments : none
5314
5315 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5316 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5317 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5318 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5319 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5320 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5321 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5322 appropriate server.
5323
5324 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5325 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5326
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005327 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005328 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005329
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005330
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005331persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005332persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005333 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5335 yes | no | yes | yes
5336 Arguments :
5337 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005338 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5339 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005340
5341 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5342 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5343 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5344 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5345 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5346 forwarded to this server.
5347
5348 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5349 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5350 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005351 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005352 a single "listen" section.
5353
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005354 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5355 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5356 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5357
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005358 Example :
5359 listen tse-farm
5360 bind :3389
5361 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5362 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5363 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5364 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5365 persist rdp-cookie
5366 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005367 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005368 balance rdp-cookie
5369 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5370 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5371
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005372 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5373 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005374
5375
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005376rate-limit sessions <rate>
5377 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5379 yes | yes | yes | no
5380 Arguments :
5381 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5382 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5383
5384 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5385 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5386 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5387 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5388 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5389 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5390
5391 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5392 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5393 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5394 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5395
5396 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5397 listen smtp
5398 mode tcp
5399 bind :25
5400 rate-limit sessions 10
5401 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5402
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005403 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5404 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5405 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005406
5407 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5408
5409
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005410redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5411redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5412redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005413 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5415 no | yes | yes | yes
5416
5417 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005418 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005419
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005420 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005421 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005422 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5423 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5424 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005425
5426 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5427 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5428 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5429 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5430 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005431 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5432 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5433 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5434 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005435
5436 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5437 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5438 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5439 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5440 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5441 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005442 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005443 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005444 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5445 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5446 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005447
5448 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005449 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5450 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5451 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmann6c7351b2015-08-03 11:42:50 +02005452 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005453 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5454 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5455 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5456 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005457
5458 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5459 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5460
5461 - "drop-query"
5462 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5463 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5464 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5465 with a location-type redirect.
5466
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005467 - "append-slash"
5468 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5469 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5470 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5471 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5472
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005473 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5474 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5475 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5476 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5477 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5478 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5479 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5480
5481 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5482 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5483 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5484 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5485 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5486 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5487 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005488
5489 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5490 acl clear dst_port 80
5491 acl secure dst_port 8080
5492 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005493 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005494 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005495 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5496
5497 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005498 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5499 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5500 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005501 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005502
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005503 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5504 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5505 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5506
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005507 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005508 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005509
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005510 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5511 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5512 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005514 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005515
5516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005517redisp (deprecated)
5518redispatch (deprecated)
5519 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5520 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5521 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005522 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005523
5524 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5525 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5526 be able to access the service anymore.
5527
5528 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5529 redistribute them to a working server.
5530
5531 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5532 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5533 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005535 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5536 "option redispatch" instead.
5537
5538 See also : "option redispatch"
5539
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005540
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005541reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005542 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5544 no | yes | yes | yes
5545 Arguments :
5546 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5547 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005548 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005549
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005550 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5551 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5552
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005553 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5554 the last header of an HTTP request.
5555
5556 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5557 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5558 responses.
5559
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005560 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5561 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5562 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5563
5564 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5565 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005566
5567
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005568reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5569reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005570 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5572 no | yes | yes | yes
5573 Arguments :
5574 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5575 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5576 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5577 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5578 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5579 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5580 ignores case.
5581
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005582 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5583 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5584
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005585 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5586 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5587 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5588 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005589 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005590
5591 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5592 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5593
5594 Example :
5595 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5596 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5597 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5598
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005599 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5600 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005601
5602
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005603reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5604reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005605 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5607 no | yes | yes | yes
5608 Arguments :
5609 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5610 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5611 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5612 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5613 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5614 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5615
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005616 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5617 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5618
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005619 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5620 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5621 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5622 next servers.
5623
5624 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5625 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5626 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5627
5628 Example :
5629 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5630 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5631 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5632
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005633 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5634 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005635
5636
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005637reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5638reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005639 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5641 no | yes | yes | yes
5642 Arguments :
5643 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5644 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5645 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5646 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5647 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5648 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5649 case.
5650
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005651 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5652 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5653
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005654 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5655 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5656 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5657 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005658 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005659
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005660 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005661 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005662 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005663
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005664 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5665 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5666
5667 Example :
5668 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5669 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5670 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5671
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005672 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5673 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005674
5675
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005676reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5677reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005678 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5680 no | yes | yes | yes
5681 Arguments :
5682 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5683 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5684 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5685 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5686 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5687 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5688 case.
5689
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005690 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5691 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5692
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005693 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5694 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5695 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5696 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5697
5698 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5699 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5700
5701 Example :
5702 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5703 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5704 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5705 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5706
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005707 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5708 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005709
5710
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005711reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5712reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005713 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5715 no | yes | yes | yes
5716 Arguments :
5717 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5718 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5719 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5720 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5721 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5722 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5723
5724 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5725 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5726 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5727 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005728 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005729
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005730 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5731 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5732
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005733 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5734 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5735 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5736
5737 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5738 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5739 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5740 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5741 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5742
5743 Example :
5744 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005745 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005746 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5747 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5748
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005749 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5750 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005751
5752
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005753reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5754reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005755 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5757 no | yes | yes | yes
5758 Arguments :
5759 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5760 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5761 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5762 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5763 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5764 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5765 ignores case.
5766
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005767 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5768 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5769
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005770 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5771 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005772 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5773 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5774 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005775 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5776 not set.
5777
5778 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5779 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5780 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5781 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5782 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5783
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005784 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005785 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5786 # block all others.
5787 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5788 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5789
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005790 # block bad guys
5791 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5792 reqitarpit . if badguys
5793
5794 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5795 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005796
5797
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005798retries <value>
5799 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5800 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5801 yes | no | yes | yes
5802 Arguments :
5803 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5804 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5805 default value is 3.
5806
5807 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5808 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5809 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5810
5811 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5812 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5813
5814 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5815 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5816
5817 See also : "option redispatch"
5818
5819
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005820rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005821 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5823 no | yes | yes | yes
5824 Arguments :
5825 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5826 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005827 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005828
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005829 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5830 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5831
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005832 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5833 the last header of an HTTP response.
5834
5835 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5836 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5837 responses.
5838
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005839 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5840 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005841
5842
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005843rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5844rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005845 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5847 no | yes | yes | yes
5848 Arguments :
5849 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5850 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5851 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5852 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5853 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5854 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5855 ignores case.
5856
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005857 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5858 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5859
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005860 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5861 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005862 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005863 client.
5864
5865 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5866 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5867 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5868
5869 Example :
5870 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005871 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005872
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005873 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5874 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005875
5876
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005877rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5878rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005879 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5881 no | yes | yes | yes
5882 Arguments :
5883 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5884 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5885 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5886 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5887 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5888 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5889 ignores case.
5890
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005891 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5892 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5893
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005894 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5895 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5896 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5897 case-sensitive.
5898
5899 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005900 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5901 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5902 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005903
5904 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5905 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5906
5907 Example :
5908 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5909 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5910
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005911 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5912 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005913
5914
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005915rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5916rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005917 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5919 no | yes | yes | yes
5920 Arguments :
5921 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5922 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5923 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5924 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5925 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5926 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5927 ignores case.
5928
5929 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5930 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5931 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5932 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005933 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005934
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005935 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5936 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5937
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005938 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5939 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5940 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5941
5942 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5943 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5944 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5945 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5946 are not case-sensitive.
5947
5948 Example :
5949 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5950 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5951
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005952 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5953 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005954
5955
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005956server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005957 Declare a server in a backend
5958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5959 no | no | yes | yes
5960 Arguments :
5961 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005962 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005963 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005964
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005965 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5966 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5967 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5968 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005969 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5970 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5971 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5972 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5973 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005974 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5975 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5976 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5977 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5978 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5979 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5980 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005981 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005982 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5983 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5984 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5985 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005986
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005987 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005988 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5989 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5990 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5991 adding this value to the client's port.
5992
5993 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5994 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005995 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005996
5997 Examples :
5998 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5999 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006000 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006001 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
6002 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
6003 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006004
Willy Tarreauf0c95fc2015-09-27 15:03:15 +02006005 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
6006 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
6007 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
6008 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
6009 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
6010
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006011 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6012 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006013
6014
6015source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006016source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006017source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006018 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6020 yes | no | yes | yes
6021 Arguments :
6022 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6023 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006024
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006025 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006026 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6027 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6028 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6029 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6030 supported prefixes are :
6031 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6032 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6033 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006034 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006035 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6036 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6037 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6038 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006039
6040 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6041 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006042 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6043 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6044 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006045
6046 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6047 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6048 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6049 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6050 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6051 <addr>.
6052
6053 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6054 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6055 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6056 port.
6057
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006058 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6059 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6060 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6061 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006062 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006063 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6064 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6065 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6066 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6067 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6068 HTTP header.
6069
6070 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6071 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006072 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006073 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6074 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6075 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6076 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6077 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6078 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6079 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6080
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006081 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6082 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6083 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6084 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6085 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6086 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6087
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006088 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6089 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6090 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6091 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6092
6093 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6094 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6095 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6096 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6097 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6098 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6099
6100 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6101 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6102 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6103 there are two methods :
6104
6105 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6106 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6107 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6108 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6109 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6110 of the client ranges may be used.
6111
6112 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6113 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6114 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6115 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6116 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6117 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6118 same session.
6119
6120 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6121 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6122 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6123 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6124 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6125 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6126
6127 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6128 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6129 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006130 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006131
Baptiste Assmannea31f222015-07-17 21:59:42 +02006132 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
6133
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006134 Examples :
6135 backend private
6136 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6137 source 192.168.1.200
6138
6139 backend transparent_ssl1
6140 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6141 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6142
6143 backend transparent_ssl2
6144 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6145 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6146 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6147
6148 backend transparent_ssl3
6149 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6150 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6151 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6152
6153 backend transparent_smtp
6154 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6155 # with Tproxy version 4.
6156 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6157
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006158 backend transparent_http
6159 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6160 # proxy.
6161 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006163 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006164 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6165
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006166
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006167srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6168 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6170 yes | no | yes | yes
6171 Arguments :
6172 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6173 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6174 as explained at the top of this document.
6175
6176 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6177 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6178 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6179 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6180 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6181 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6182 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6183
6184 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6185 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6186 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6187 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6188 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006189 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006190 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006191 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006192
6193 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6194 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6195 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6196 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6197 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6198 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6199
6200 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6201 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6202
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006203 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6204 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006205
6206
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006207stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6208 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006210 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006211
6212 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6213 matched.
6214
6215 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6216 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6217
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006218 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6219 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6220 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6221
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006222 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6223 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6224 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6225 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006226
6227 Example :
6228 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6229 backend stats_localhost
6230 stats enable
6231 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6232
6233 Example :
6234 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6235 backend stats_auth
6236 stats enable
6237 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6238 stats admin if TRUE
6239
6240 Example :
6241 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6242 userlist stats-auth
6243 group admin users admin
6244 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6245 group readonly users haproxy
6246 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6247
6248 backend stats_auth
6249 stats enable
6250 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6251 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6252 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6253 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6254
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006255 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6256 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6257 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006258
6259
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006260stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6261 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006263 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006264 Arguments :
6265 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6266
6267 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6268
6269 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6270 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6271 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6272 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6273 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6274 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6275
6276 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6277 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6278 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006279 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006280
6281 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6282 report using "stats scope".
6283
6284 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6285 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6286 unobvious parameters.
6287
6288 Example :
6289 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6290 backend public_www
6291 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6292 stats enable
6293 stats hide-version
6294 stats scope .
6295 stats uri /admin?stats
6296 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6297 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6298 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6299
6300 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6301 backend private_monitoring
6302 stats enable
6303 stats uri /admin?stats
6304 stats refresh 5s
6305
6306 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6307
6308
6309stats enable
6310 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006312 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006313 Arguments : none
6314
6315 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6316 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6317 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6318 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6319 - stats auth : no authentication
6320 - stats scope : no restriction
6321
6322 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6323 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6324 unobvious parameters.
6325
6326 Example :
6327 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6328 backend public_www
6329 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6330 stats enable
6331 stats hide-version
6332 stats scope .
6333 stats uri /admin?stats
6334 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6335 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6336 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6337
6338 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6339 backend private_monitoring
6340 stats enable
6341 stats uri /admin?stats
6342 stats refresh 5s
6343
6344 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6345
6346
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006347stats hide-version
6348 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006350 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006351 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006352
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006353 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6354 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6355 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6356 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6357 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6358 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006359
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006360 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6361 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6362 unobvious parameters.
6363
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006364 Example :
6365 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6366 backend public_www
6367 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006368 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006369 stats hide-version
6370 stats scope .
6371 stats uri /admin?stats
6372 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6373 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6374 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006375
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006376 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6377 backend private_monitoring
6378 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006379 stats uri /admin?stats
6380 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006381
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006382 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006383
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006384
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006385stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6386 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6387 Access control for statistics
6388
6389 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6390 no | no | yes | yes
6391
6392 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6393 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6394 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6395 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6396 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6397 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6398
6399 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6400 instance.
6401
6402 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6403 about ACL usage.
6404
6405
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006406stats realm <realm>
6407 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006409 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006410 Arguments :
6411 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6412 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6413 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6414
6415 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6416 using a backslash ('\').
6417
6418 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6419 only related to authentication.
6420
6421 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6422 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6423 unobvious parameters.
6424
6425 Example :
6426 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6427 backend public_www
6428 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6429 stats enable
6430 stats hide-version
6431 stats scope .
6432 stats uri /admin?stats
6433 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6434 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6435 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6436
6437 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6438 backend private_monitoring
6439 stats enable
6440 stats uri /admin?stats
6441 stats refresh 5s
6442
6443 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6444
6445
6446stats refresh <delay>
6447 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006449 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006450 Arguments :
6451 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6452 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6453 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6454 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6455 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6456 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6457
6458 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6459 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6460 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6461 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6462
6463 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6464 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6465 unobvious parameters.
6466
6467 Example :
6468 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6469 backend public_www
6470 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6471 stats enable
6472 stats hide-version
6473 stats scope .
6474 stats uri /admin?stats
6475 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6476 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6477 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6478
6479 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6480 backend private_monitoring
6481 stats enable
6482 stats uri /admin?stats
6483 stats refresh 5s
6484
6485 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6486
6487
6488stats scope { <name> | "." }
6489 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006491 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006492 Arguments :
6493 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6494 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6495 section in which the statement appears.
6496
6497 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6498 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6499 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6500 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6501 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6502 exists.
6503
6504 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6505 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6506 unobvious parameters.
6507
6508 Example :
6509 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6510 backend public_www
6511 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6512 stats enable
6513 stats hide-version
6514 stats scope .
6515 stats uri /admin?stats
6516 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6517 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6518 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6519
6520 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6521 backend private_monitoring
6522 stats enable
6523 stats uri /admin?stats
6524 stats refresh 5s
6525
6526 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6527
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006528
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006529stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006530 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006532 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006533
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006534 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006535 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6536
6537 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6538 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6539
6540 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6541 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006542 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006543
6544 Example :
6545 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6546 backend private_monitoring
6547 stats enable
6548 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6549 stats uri /admin?stats
6550 stats refresh 5s
6551
6552 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6553 global section.
6554
6555
6556stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006557 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6559 yes | yes | yes | yes
6560 Arguments : none
6561
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006562 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006563 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6564 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6565 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6566 - IP (socket, server)
6567 - cookie (backend, server)
6568
6569 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6570 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006571 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006572
6573 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6574
6575
6576stats show-node [ <name> ]
6577 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006579 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006580 Arguments:
6581 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6582 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6583
6584 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6585 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006586 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006587
6588 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6589 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6590 unobvious parameters.
6591
6592 Example:
6593 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6594 backend private_monitoring
6595 stats enable
6596 stats show-node Europe-1
6597 stats uri /admin?stats
6598 stats refresh 5s
6599
6600 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6601 section.
6602
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006603
6604stats uri <prefix>
6605 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006607 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006608 Arguments :
6609 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6610 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6611 query string.
6612
6613 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6614 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6615 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6616 possible to reach it in the application.
6617
6618 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006619 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006620 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6621 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6622 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6623 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6624
6625 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6626 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6627 an address or a port to statistics only.
6628
6629 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6630 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6631 unobvious parameters.
6632
6633 Example :
6634 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6635 backend public_www
6636 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6637 stats enable
6638 stats hide-version
6639 stats scope .
6640 stats uri /admin?stats
6641 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6642 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6643 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6644
6645 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6646 backend private_monitoring
6647 stats enable
6648 stats uri /admin?stats
6649 stats refresh 5s
6650
6651 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6652
6653
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006654stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6655 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006657 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006658
6659 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006660 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006661 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6662 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6663 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6664
6665 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6666 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6667 the "stick-table" statement.
6668
6669 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6670 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6671 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6672 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6673 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6674
6675 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6676 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6677 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6678 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6679 transformation rules.
6680
6681 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6682 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6683 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6684 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6685 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6686 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6687 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6688
6689 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6690 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6691 ACL based conditions.
6692
6693 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6694 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6695 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6696 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6697
6698 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6699 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6700 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6701 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6702
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006703 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6704 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6705 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6706
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006707 Example :
6708 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6709 # last 30 minutes
6710 backend pop
6711 mode tcp
6712 balance roundrobin
6713 stick store-request src
6714 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6715 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6716 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6717
6718 backend smtp
6719 mode tcp
6720 balance roundrobin
6721 stick match src table pop
6722 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6723 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6724
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006725 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006726 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006727
6728
6729stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6730 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6732 no | no | yes | yes
6733
6734 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6735 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6736 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6737 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6738
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006739 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6740 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6741 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6742
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006743 Examples :
6744 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006745 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006746
6747 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6748 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6749 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6750
6751
6752 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6753 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6754 backend http
6755 mode http
6756 balance roundrobin
6757 stick on src table https
6758 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6759 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6760 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6761
6762 backend https
6763 mode tcp
6764 balance roundrobin
6765 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6766 stick on src
6767 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6768 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6769
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006770 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006771
6772
6773stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6774 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6776 no | no | yes | yes
6777
6778 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006779 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006780 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6781 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6782 server is selected.
6783
6784 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6785 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6786 the "stick-table" statement.
6787
6788 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6789 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6790 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6791 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6792 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6793 address.
6794
6795 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6796 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6797 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6798 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6799 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6800 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6801 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6802 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6803 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6804 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6805
6806 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6807 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6808 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6809 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6810 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6811 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6812 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6813
6814 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6815 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6816 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6817 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6818
6819 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6820 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6821 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6822 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6823 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6824 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006825 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6826 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6827 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6828 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6829 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6830 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006831
6832 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6833 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6834 the request.
6835
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006836 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6837 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6838 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6839
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006840 Example :
6841 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6842 # last 30 minutes
6843 backend pop
6844 mode tcp
6845 balance roundrobin
6846 stick store-request src
6847 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6848 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6849 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6850
6851 backend smtp
6852 mode tcp
6853 balance roundrobin
6854 stick match src table pop
6855 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6856 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6857
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006858 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006859 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006860
6861
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006862stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006863 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6864 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006865 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006867 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006868
6869 Arguments :
6870 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6871 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6872 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6873 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6874
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006875 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6876 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6877 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6878 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6879
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006880 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6881 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6882 instance.
6883
6884 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6885 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6886 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6887 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6888 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6889 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006890 to 32 characters.
6891
6892 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6893 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6894 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006895 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006896 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6897 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006898
6899 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006900 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6901 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006902 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6903 increase.
6904
6905 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006906 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6907 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6908 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006909
6910 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6911 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6912 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6913 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6914 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6915 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6916 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6917 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6918 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6919 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6920 parameter (see below).
6921
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006922 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6923 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6924 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6925 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6926 soft restart.
6927
Willy Tarreauc85ad792015-05-01 19:21:02 +02006928 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
6929 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006930
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006931 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6932 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6933 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6934 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6935 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006936 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006937 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6938 if not expiration delay is specified.
6939
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006940 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6941 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6942 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6943 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006944 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6945 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6946 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6947 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6948 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6949 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6950 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6951 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6952 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6953 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6954 types and their arguments.
6955
6956 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6957 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6958 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6959 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6960
6961 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6962 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6963 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6964 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6965
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006966 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6967 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6968 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6969 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6970 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6971 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6972
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006973 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6974 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6975 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6976 they were received.
6977
6978 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6979 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6980 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6981 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6982 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6983
6984 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6985 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6986 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6987 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6988 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6989
6990 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6991 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6992 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6993
6994 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6995 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6996 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6997 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6998 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6999
7000 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7001 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7002 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7003 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7004 the client side.
7005
7006 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7007 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7008 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7009 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7010 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7011 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7012 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7013
7014 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7015 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7016 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7017 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7018 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7019 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7020 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7021
7022 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7023 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7024 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7025 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7026 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7027 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7028
7029 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7030 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7031 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7032 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7033
7034 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7035 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7036 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7037 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7038 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7039 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7040 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7041 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7042 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7043 recommended for better fairness.
7044
7045 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7046 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7047 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7048 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7049
7050 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7051 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7052 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7053 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7054 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7055 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7056 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7057 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7058 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7059 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007060
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007061 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7062 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007063 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7064 reference it.
7065
7066 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7067 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7068 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7069 as an exclusive stickiness.
7070
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007071 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7072 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7073 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7074 something that can be ignored.
7075
7076 Example:
7077 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7078 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7079 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7080 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7081
7082 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007083 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007084
7085
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007086stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7087 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7089 no | no | yes | yes
7090
7091 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007092 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007093 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7094 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7095 server is selected.
7096
7097 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7098 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7099 the "stick-table" statement.
7100
7101 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7102 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7103 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7104 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7105
7106 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7107 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7108 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7109 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7110 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7111 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007112 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007113 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7114 rules.
7115
7116 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7117 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7118 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7119 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7120 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7121 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7122 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7123
7124 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7125 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7126 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7127 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7128
7129 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7130 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7131 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7132 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7133 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7134 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007135 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7136 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7137 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7138 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7139 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7140 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7141 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7142 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7143 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007144
7145 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7146
7147 Example :
7148 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7149 backend https
7150 mode tcp
7151 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007152 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007153 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007154
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007155 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7156 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7157
7158 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7159 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7160 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7161
7162 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7163 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007164
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007165 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7166 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7167 # at offset 44.
7168
7169 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7170 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7171
7172 # Learn on response if server hello.
7173 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007174
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007175 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7176 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7177
7178 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7179 extraction.
7180
7181
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007182tcp-check connect [params*]
7183 Opens a new connection
7184 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7185 no | no | yes | yes
7186
7187 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7188 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7189 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7190
7191 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7192 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7193 of the sequence.
7194
7195 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7196 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7197 do.
7198
7199 Parameters :
7200 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7201 use the TCP connection.
7202
7203 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7204 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7205 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7206
7207 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7208
7209 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7210
7211 Examples:
7212 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7213 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7214 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7215 option tcp-check
7216 tcp-check connect
7217 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7218 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7219 tcp-check send \r\n
7220 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7221 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7222 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7223 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7224 tcp-check send \r\n
7225 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7226 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7227
7228 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7229 option tcp-check
7230 tcp-check connect port 110
7231 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7232 tcp-check connect port 143
7233 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7234 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7235
7236 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7237
7238
7239tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7240 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7241 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7242 no | no | yes | yes
7243
7244 Arguments :
7245 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7246 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7247 binary.
7248 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7249 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7250 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7251
7252 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7253 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7254 with the usual backslash ('\').
7255 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7256 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7257 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7258 used upper or lower case.
7259
7260
7261 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7262
7263 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7264 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7265 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7266 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7267 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7268 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7269 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7270 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7271
7272 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7273 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7274 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7275 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7276 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7277 expression.
7278
7279 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7280 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7281 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7282 this exact hexadecimal string.
7283 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7284
7285 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7286 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7287 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7288 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7289 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7290 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7291 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7292 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7293 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7294 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7295 the null character.
7296
7297 Examples :
7298 # perform a POP check
7299 option tcp-check
7300 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7301
7302 # perform an IMAP check
7303 option tcp-check
7304 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7305
7306 # look for the redis master server
7307 option tcp-check
7308 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7309 tcp-check expect +PONG
7310 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7311 tcp-check expect string role:master
7312 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7313 tcp-check expect string +OK
7314
7315
7316 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7317 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7318
7319
7320tcp-check send <data>
7321 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7322 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7323 no | no | yes | yes
7324
7325 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7326 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7327
7328 Examples :
7329 # look for the redis master server
7330 option tcp-check
7331 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7332 tcp-check expect string role:master
7333
7334 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7335 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7336
7337
7338tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7339 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7340 tcp health check
7341 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7342 no | no | yes | yes
7343
7344 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7345 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7346 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7347 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7348 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7349 hexadecimal string.
7350 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7351
7352 Examples :
7353 # redis check in binary
7354 option tcp-check
7355 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7356 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7357
7358
7359 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7360 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7361
7362
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007363tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7364 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7366 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007367 Arguments :
7368 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007369 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7370 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007371
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007372 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007373
7374 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7375 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007376 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7377 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7378 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7379 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7380 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7381 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007382
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007383 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7384 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7385 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7386 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007387
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007388 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007389 - accept :
7390 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7391 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7392 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007393
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007394 - reject :
7395 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7396 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7397 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7398 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7399 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7400 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7401 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7402 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7403 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7404 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7405 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7406 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007407
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007408 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7409 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7410 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7411 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7412 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7413 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7414 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7415 hosts.
7416
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007417 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7418 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7419 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7420 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7421 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7422 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7423 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7424 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7425 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7426 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7427 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7428
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007429 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007430 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7431 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7432 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007433 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7434 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007435 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007436 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7437 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7438 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7439 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7440 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007441
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007442 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007443 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007444 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007445 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7446 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7447 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7448 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007449
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007450 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7451 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7452 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7453 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007454
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007455 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7456 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7457 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7458 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7459 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007460 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7461 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7462 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7463 layer7 information is extracted.
7464
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007465 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7466 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7467 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7468 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7469 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007470
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007471 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7472 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7473 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007474
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007475 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7476 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7477 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007478
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007479 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007480 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007481 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007482
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007483 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7484 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7485 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007486
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007487 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007488 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7489 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007490
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007491 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7492
7493 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7494
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007495 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7496
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007497 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007498
7499
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007500tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7501 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007503 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007504 Arguments :
7505 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007506 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007507 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7508 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007509
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007510 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007511
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007512 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7513 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7514 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7515 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7516 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007517
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007518 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7519 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7520 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7521 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007522 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7523 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7524 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7525 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7526 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7527 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007528 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007529 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007530
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007531 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7532 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7533 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7534 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007535
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007536 Four types of actions are supported :
7537 - accept : the request is accepted
7538 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7539 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007540 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007541
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007542 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7543 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007544
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007545 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7546 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7547 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7548 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7549 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7550 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007551
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007552 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007553 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7554 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007555
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007556 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007557 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7558 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7559 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7560 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007561 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7562 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7563 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007564
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007565 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007566 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7567 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7568 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007569
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007570 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007571 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7572 # and reject everything else.
7573 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7574 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007575 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007576 tcp-request content reject
7577
7578 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007579 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7580 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7581 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007582 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007583
7584 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7585 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7586 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007587 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007588 tcp-request content reject
7589
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007590 Example:
7591 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7592 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007593 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007594
7595 Example:
7596 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7597 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007598 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007599
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007600 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7601 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7602
7603 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007604 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007605 # protecting all our sites
7606 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007607 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7608 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007609 ...
7610 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7611
7612 backend http_dynamic
7613 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007614 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007615 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007616 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7617 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7618 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007619 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007620
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007621 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007622
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007623 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007624
7625
7626tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7627 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007629 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007630 Arguments :
7631 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7632 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7633 as explained at the top of this document.
7634
7635 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7636 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7637 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7638 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7639 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7640
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007641 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7642 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7643 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7644 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7645
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007646 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7647 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007648 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007649 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007650 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7651 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7652 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7653 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007654
7655 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7656 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7657 it pass through unaffected.
7658
7659 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7660 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7661 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007662 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007663 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7664 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007665 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7666 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7667 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007668
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007669 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007670 "timeout client".
7671
7672
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007673tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7674 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7676 no | no | yes | yes
7677 Arguments :
7678 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007679 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007680
7681 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7682
7683 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7684 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7685 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007686 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7687 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007688
7689 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7690
7691 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7692 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7693 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7694 inserted.
7695
7696 Two types of actions are supported :
7697 - accept :
7698 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7699 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7700 the rules evaluation.
7701
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007702 - close :
7703 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7704 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7705 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7706 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7707 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7708 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007709 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007710 protocols.
7711
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007712 - reject :
7713 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7714 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007715 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007716
7717 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7718 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7719 for changing the default action to a reject.
7720
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007721 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7722 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7723 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7724 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007725 period.
7726
7727 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7728
7729 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7730
7731
7732tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7733 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7735 no | no | yes | yes
7736 Arguments :
7737 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7738 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7739 as explained at the top of this document.
7740
7741 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7742
7743
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007744timeout check <timeout>
7745 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7746 established.
7747
7748 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7749 yes | no | yes | yes
7750 Arguments:
7751 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7752 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7753 as explained at the top of this document.
7754
7755 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7756 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7757 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7758 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007759 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7760 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7761 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007762
7763 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7764 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7765
7766 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7767 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007768 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007769
7770 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7771 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7772 forget about it.
7773
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007774 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7775 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007776
7777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007778timeout client <timeout>
7779timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7780 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7782 yes | yes | yes | no
7783 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007784 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007785 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7786 as explained at the top of this document.
7787
7788 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7789 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7790 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7791 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7792 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7793 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7794 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7795 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007796 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007797 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007798 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7799 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007800 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7801 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007802
7803 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7804 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7805 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7806 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7807 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7808 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7809
7810 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7811 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7812 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7813
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007814 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007815
7816
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007817timeout client-fin <timeout>
7818 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7820 yes | yes | yes | no
7821 Arguments :
7822 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7823 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7824 as explained at the top of this document.
7825
7826 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7827 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7828 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7829 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7830 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7831 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7832 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7833 down in one direction.
7834
7835 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7836 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7837 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7838
7839 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7840
7841
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007842timeout connect <timeout>
7843timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7844 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7846 yes | no | yes | yes
7847 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007848 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007849 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7850 as explained at the top of this document.
7851
7852 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007853 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007854 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007855 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007856 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7857 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007858
7859 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7860 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7861 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7862 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7863 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7864 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7865
7866 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7867 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7868 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7869
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007870 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7871 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007872
7873
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007874timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7875 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7877 yes | yes | yes | yes
7878 Arguments :
7879 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7880 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7881 as explained at the top of this document.
7882
7883 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7884 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7885 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7886 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7887 once the request has started to present itself.
7888
7889 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7890 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7891 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7892 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7893 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7894
7895 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7896 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7897 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7898 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7899
7900 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7901 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7902 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7903 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7904 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007905 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007906
7907 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7908 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7909 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7910 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7911
7912 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7913
7914
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007915timeout http-request <timeout>
7916 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007918 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007919 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007920 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007921 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7922 as explained at the top of this document.
7923
7924 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7925 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7926 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7927 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7928 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7929 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7930 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007931 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7932 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7933 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7934 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7935 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007936 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
7937 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007938
7939 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7940 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007941 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7942 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007943
7944 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7945 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7946 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7947 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7948 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7949
7950 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007951 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7952 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7953 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007954
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007955 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
7956 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007957
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007958
7959timeout queue <timeout>
7960 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7962 yes | no | yes | yes
7963 Arguments :
7964 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7965 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7966 as explained at the top of this document.
7967
7968 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7969 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7970 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7971 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7972 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7973
7974 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7975 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7976 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7977 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7978
7979 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7980
7981
7982timeout server <timeout>
7983timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7984 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7986 yes | no | yes | yes
7987 Arguments :
7988 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7989 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7990 as explained at the top of this document.
7991
7992 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7993 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7994 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7995 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7996 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7997 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7998 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7999
8000 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8001 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8002 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8003 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8004 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008005 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008006 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008007 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8008 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8009 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8010 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008011
8012 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8013 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8014 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8015 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8016 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8017 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8018
8019 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8020 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8021 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8022
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008023 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008024
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008025
8026timeout server-fin <timeout>
8027 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8029 yes | no | yes | yes
8030 Arguments :
8031 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8032 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8033 as explained at the top of this document.
8034
8035 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8036 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8037 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8038 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8039 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8040 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8041 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8042 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8043 situations, it should not be needed.
8044
8045 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8046 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8047 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8048
8049 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8050
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008051
8052timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008053 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8055 yes | yes | yes | yes
8056 Arguments :
8057 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8058 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8059 as explained at the top of this document.
8060
8061 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8062 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8063 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8064
8065 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8066 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8067 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8068 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008069 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008070
8071 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8072
8073
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008074timeout tunnel <timeout>
8075 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8077 yes | no | yes | yes
8078 Arguments :
8079 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8080 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8081 as explained at the top of this document.
8082
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008083 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008084 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8085 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8086 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8087 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8088 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8089 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8090 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8091 specified.
8092
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008093 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8094 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8095 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8096 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8097 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8098 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8099 state.
8100
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008101 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8102 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8103 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8104 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8105 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8106
8107 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8108 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8109 forget about it.
8110
8111 Example :
8112 defaults http
8113 option http-server-close
8114 timeout connect 5s
8115 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008116 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008117 timeout server 30s
8118 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8119
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008120 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008121
8122
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008123transparent (deprecated)
8124 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008126 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008127 Arguments : none
8128
8129 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8130 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8131 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8132 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8133 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8134 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8135 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8136 appropriate server.
8137
8138 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8139
8140 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8141 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8142
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008143 See also: "option transparent"
8144
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008145unique-id-format <string>
8146 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8148 yes | yes | yes | no
8149 Arguments :
8150 <string> is a log-format string.
8151
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008152 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8153 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8154 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8155 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008156
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008157 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8158 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8159 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8160 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8161 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8162 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8163 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8164 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008165
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008166 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8167 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008168
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008169 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008170
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008171 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008172
8173 will generate:
8174
8175 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8176
8177 See also: "unique-id-header"
8178
8179unique-id-header <name>
8180 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8182 yes | yes | yes | no
8183 Arguments :
8184 <name> is the name of the header.
8185
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008186 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8187 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008188
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008189 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008190
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008191 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008192 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8193
8194 will generate:
8195
8196 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8197
8198 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008199
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008200use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008201 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8203 no | yes | yes | no
8204 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008205 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8206 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008207
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008208 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8209 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008210
8211 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8212 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8213 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008214 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8215 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8216 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8217 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008218
8219 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8220 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8221 assign the backend.
8222
8223 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8224 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8225 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8226 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8227 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8228 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8229
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008230 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008231 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008232 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8233 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8234 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8235
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008236 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8237 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8238 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8239 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8240 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8241 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8242 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8243 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8244 cannot be forced from the request.
8245
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008246 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008247 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8248 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8249
8250 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8251 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008252
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008253
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008254use-server <server> if <condition>
8255use-server <server> unless <condition>
8256 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8258 no | no | yes | yes
8259 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008260 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008261
8262 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8263
8264 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8265 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8266 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8267
8268 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8269 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8270 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8271 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8272 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8273 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8274 matches will assign the server.
8275
8276 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8277 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8278 with the next rules until one matches.
8279
8280 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8281 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8282 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8283 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8284
8285 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8286 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8287 stripped.
8288
8289 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8290 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8291 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8292 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8293
8294 Example :
8295 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8296 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8297 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8298 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8299 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8300 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8301 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8302 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8303 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8304
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008305 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008306
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008307
83085. Bind and Server options
8309--------------------------
8310
8311The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8312depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8313settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8314written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8315described in this section.
8316
8317
83185.1. Bind options
8319-----------------
8320
8321The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8322as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8323no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8324parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8325while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8326provided immediately after the setting name.
8327
8328The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8329
8330accept-proxy
8331 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008332 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8333 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008334 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8335 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8336 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8337 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8338 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8339 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8340 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008341 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8342 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008343
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008344alpn <protocols>
8345 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8346 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8347 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8348 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8349 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8350 initial NPN extension.
8351
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008352backlog <backlog>
8353 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8354 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8355
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008356ecdhe <named curve>
8357 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008358 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8359 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008360
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008361ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008362 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8363 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8364 client's certificate.
8365
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008366ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8367 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8368 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8369 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8370 error is ignored.
8371
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008372ciphers <ciphers>
8373 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8374 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008375 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008376 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8377 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8378
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008379crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008380 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8381 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8382 to verify client's certificate.
8383
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008384crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008385 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8386 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8387 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8388 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8389 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8390 file.
8391
8392 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8393 are loaded.
8394
8395 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté62043c92015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008396 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
8397 '.issuer' or '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified
8398 multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
8399 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
8400 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects.
8401 Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the
8402 first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008403 www.sub.example.org).
8404
8405 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8406 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8407 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8408 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté62043c92015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008409 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
8410 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008411
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008412 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008413
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008414 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8415 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008416 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008417 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8418 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8419 clients).
8420
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008421 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8422 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8423 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8424 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8425 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8426 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8427 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8428 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8429 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8430 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8431 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8432 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8433 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8434
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008435crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008436 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8437 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008438 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008439 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008440
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008441crt-list <file>
8442 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008443 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8444 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008445
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008446 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008447
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008448 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8449 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8450 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8451 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8452 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8453 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8454 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8455 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008456
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008457defer-accept
8458 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8459 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8460 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8461 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8462 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8463 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8464 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8465 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8466 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8467 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8468 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8469
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008470force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008471 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008472 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008473 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8474 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008475
8476force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008477 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008478 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8479 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008480
8481force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008482 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008483 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8484 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008485
8486force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008487 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008488 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8489 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008490
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008491gid <gid>
8492 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8493 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8494 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8495 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8496 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8497
8498group <group>
8499 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8500 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8501 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8502 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8503 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8504
8505id <id>
8506 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8507 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8508 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8509 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8510
8511interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008512 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8513 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8514 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8515 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8516 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8517 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8518 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008519
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008520level <level>
8521 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8522 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8523 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8524 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8525 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8526 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8527 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8528 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8529 counters).
8530 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8531 all counters).
8532
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008533maxconn <maxconn>
8534 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8535 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8536 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8537 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8538 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8539 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8540 eat all memory.
8541
8542mode <mode>
8543 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8544 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8545 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8546 UNIX sockets.
8547
8548mss <maxseg>
8549 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8550 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8551 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8552 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8553 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8554 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8555 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8556 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8557 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8558 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8559 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8560
8561name <name>
8562 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8563 page.
8564
8565nice <nice>
8566 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8567 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8568 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8569 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8570 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8571 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8572 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8573 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8574 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8575 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8576 one for an RDP socket.
8577
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008578no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008579 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008580 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008581 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008582 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8583 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008584 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008585
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008586no-tls-tickets
8587 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8588 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8589 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008590 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8591 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008592
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008593no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008594 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008595 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008596 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008597 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8598 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8599 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008600
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008601no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008602 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008603 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008604 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008605 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8606 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8607 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008608
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008609no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008610 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008611 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008612 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008613 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8614 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8615 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008616
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008617npn <protocols>
8618 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8619 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8620 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8621 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008622 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8623 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008624
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008625process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8626 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8627 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8628 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8629 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8630 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8631 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8632 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008633 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8634 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8635 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8636 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8637 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8638 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8639 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008640
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008641ssl
8642 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008643 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008644 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8645 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8646 to deciphered contents.
8647
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008648strict-sni
8649 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8650 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8651 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8652 See the "crt" option for more information.
8653
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008654tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008655 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008656 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8657 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8658 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8659 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8660 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8661 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8662 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008663 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8664 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8665 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008666
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008667transparent
8668 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8669 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8670 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8671 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8672 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8673 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8674 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8675 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8676 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8677 so check for support with your vendor.
8678
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008679v4v6
8680 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8681 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8682 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8683 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008684 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008685
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008686v6only
8687 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8688 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8689 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008690 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8691 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008692
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008693uid <uid>
8694 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8695 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8696 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8697 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8698 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8699
8700user <user>
8701 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8702 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8703 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8704 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8705 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8706
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008707verify [none|optional|required]
8708 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8709 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8710 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8711 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8712 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008713 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8714 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8715 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8716 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008717
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020087185.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008719------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008720
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008721The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8722which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8723arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8724settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8725after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8726Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8727address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008728
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008729 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008730 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008731
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008732The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008733
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008734addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008735 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8736 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8737 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8738 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8739 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008741 Supported in default-server: No
8742
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008743agent-check
8744 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008745 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8746 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8747 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8748 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008749
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008750 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008751 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreau47067ca2014-10-07 15:27:33 +02008752 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
8753 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
8754 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008755
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008756 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8757 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008758
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008759 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8760 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8761 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008762
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008763 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8764 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8765 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008766
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008767 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8768 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8769 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8770 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8771 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8772 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8773 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008774
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008775 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8776 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008777
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008778 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8779 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8780 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8781 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8782 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8783 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8784 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8785 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8786 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008787
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008788 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8789 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008790 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8791 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8792 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8793 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008794
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008795 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8796 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008797
8798 Supported in default-server: No
8799
8800agent-inter <delay>
8801 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8802 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8803
8804 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8805 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8806 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8807 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8808 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8809 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8810 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8811 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8812 of backends use the same servers.
8813
8814 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8815
8816 Supported in default-server: Yes
8817
8818agent-port <port>
8819 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8820
8821 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8822
8823 Supported in default-server: Yes
8824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008825backup
8826 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8827 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8828 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8829 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8830 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8831 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008832
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008833 Supported in default-server: No
8834
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008835ca-file <cafile>
8836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8837 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8838 server's certificate.
8839
8840 Supported in default-server: No
8841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008842check
8843 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008844 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8845 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8846 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8847 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8848 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8849 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8850 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008851 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8852 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8853 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008854
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008855 Supported in default-server: No
8856
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008857check-send-proxy
8858 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8859 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8860 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8861 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8862 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8863 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8864 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8865
8866 Supported in default-server: No
8867
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008868check-ssl
8869 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8870 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8871 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8872 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008873 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008874 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8875 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8876 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8877 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8878
8879 Supported in default-server: No
8880
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008881ciphers <ciphers>
8882 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008883 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008884 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8885 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8886 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8887 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8888 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8889 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8890
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008891 Supported in default-server: No
8892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008893cookie <value>
8894 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8895 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8896 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8897 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8898 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8899 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8900 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008902 Supported in default-server: No
8903
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008904crl-file <crlfile>
8905 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8906 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8907 to verify server's certificate.
8908
8909 Supported in default-server: No
8910
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008911crt <cert>
8912 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8913 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8914 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8915 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8916 certificate request.
8917
8918 Supported in default-server: No
8919
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008920disabled
8921 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8922 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8923 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8924 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8925 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8926
8927 Supported in default-server: No
8928
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008929error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008930 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8931 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8932 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008933
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008934 Supported in default-server: Yes
8935
8936 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008937
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008938fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008939 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8940 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8941 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008943 Supported in default-server: Yes
8944
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008945force-sslv3
8946 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8947 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008948 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8949 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008950
8951 Supported in default-server: No
8952
8953force-tlsv10
8954 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008955 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8956 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008957
8958 Supported in default-server: No
8959
8960force-tlsv11
8961 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008962 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8963 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008964
8965 Supported in default-server: No
8966
8967force-tlsv12
8968 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008969 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8970 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008971
8972 Supported in default-server: No
8973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008974id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008975 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8976 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8977 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008978
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008979 Supported in default-server: No
8980
8981inter <delay>
8982fastinter <delay>
8983downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008984 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8985 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8986 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8987 between checks depending on the server state :
8988
8989 Server state | Interval used
8990 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8991 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8992 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8993 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8994 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8995 or yet unchecked. |
8996 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8997 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8998 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009000 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9001 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9002 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9003 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009004 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9005 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9006 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9007 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9008 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009009
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009010 Supported in default-server: Yes
9011
9012maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009013 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9014 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9015 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9016 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9017 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9018 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9019 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9020 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9021
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009022 Supported in default-server: Yes
9023
9024maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009025 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9026 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9027 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9028 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9029 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9030 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9031 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9032
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009033 Supported in default-server: Yes
9034
9035minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009036 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9037 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9038 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9039 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9040 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9041 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009042 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009043 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009044
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009045 Supported in default-server: Yes
9046
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009047no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009048 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9049 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009050 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009051
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009052 Supported in default-server: No
9053
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009054no-tls-tickets
9055 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9056 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9057 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009058 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9059 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009060
9061 Supported in default-server: No
9062
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009063no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009064 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009065 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9066 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009067 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9068 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9069 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009070
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009071 Supported in default-server: No
9072
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009073no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009074 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009075 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9076 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009077 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9078 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9079 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009080
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009081 Supported in default-server: No
9082
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009083no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009084 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009085 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9086 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009087 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9088 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9089 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009090
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009091 Supported in default-server: No
9092
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009093non-stick
9094 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9095 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9096 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9097
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009098 Supported in default-server: No
9099
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009100observe <mode>
9101 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9102 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9103 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9104 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9105 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9106 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009107 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009108
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009109 Supported in default-server: No
9110
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009111 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9112
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009113on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009114 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9115 Currently, four modes are available:
9116 - fastinter: force fastinter
9117 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9118 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9119 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9120 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9121
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009122 Supported in default-server: Yes
9123
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009124 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9125
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009126on-marked-down <action>
9127 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9128 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009129 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9130 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9131 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9132 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9133 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9134 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9135 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9136 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009137
9138 Actions are disabled by default
9139
9140 Supported in default-server: Yes
9141
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009142on-marked-up <action>
9143 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9144 Currently one action is available:
9145 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9146 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9147 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9148 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9149 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9150 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9151 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9152 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9153
9154 Actions are disabled by default
9155
9156 Supported in default-server: Yes
9157
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009158port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009159 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9160 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9161 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9162 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9163 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9164 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9165
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009166 Supported in default-server: Yes
9167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009168redir <prefix>
9169 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9170 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9171 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9172 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9173 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9174 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9175 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9176 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009177 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009178 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9179 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9180 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9181 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9182 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9183
9184 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9185
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009186 Supported in default-server: No
9187
9188rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009189 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9190 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9191 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9192
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009193 Supported in default-server: Yes
9194
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009195send-proxy
9196 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9197 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9198 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9199 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9200 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9201 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9202 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9203 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9204 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009205 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9206 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9207 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9208 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9209 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009210
9211 Supported in default-server: No
9212
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009213send-proxy-v2
9214 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9215 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9216 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9217 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9218 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9219 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9220 option of the "bind" keyword.
9221
9222 Supported in default-server: No
9223
9224send-proxy-v2-ssl
9225 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9226 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9227 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9228 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9229 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9230 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9231 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9232 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9233
9234 Supported in default-server: No
9235
9236send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9237 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9238 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9239 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9240 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9241 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9242 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9243 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9244 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9245 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9246
9247 Supported in default-server: No
9248
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009249slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009250 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9251 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9252 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9253 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9254 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9255 parameters :
9256
9257 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9258 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9259
9260 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9261 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9262 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9263 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9264
9265 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9266 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9267 seen as failed.
9268
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009269 Supported in default-server: Yes
9270
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009271source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009272source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009273source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009274 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9275 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9276 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9277 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9278
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009279 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9280 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9281 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9282 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9283 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9284 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9285 server.
9286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009287 Supported in default-server: No
9288
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009289ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009290 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9291 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9292 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9293 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9294 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9295 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009296 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009297
9298 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009300track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009301 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9302 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9303 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9304 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009305 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009307 Supported in default-server: No
9308
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009309verify [none|required]
9310 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009311 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9312 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9313 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9314 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009315 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9316 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9317 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009318
9319 Supported in default-server: No
9320
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009321verifyhost <hostname>
9322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9323 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9324 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9325 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9326 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9327 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9328
9329 Supported in default-server: No
9330
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009331weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009332 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9333 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9334 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009335 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9336 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9337 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9338 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9339 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9340 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009342 Supported in default-server: Yes
9343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009344
93456. HTTP header manipulation
9346---------------------------
9347
9348In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9349response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9350request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9351which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009352against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009353
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009354If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9355to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9356but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9357HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9358stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9359because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9360a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9361still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009363This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9364in section 4.2 :
9365
9366 - reqadd <string>
9367 - reqallow <search>
9368 - reqiallow <search>
9369 - reqdel <search>
9370 - reqidel <search>
9371 - reqdeny <search>
9372 - reqideny <search>
9373 - reqpass <search>
9374 - reqipass <search>
9375 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9376 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9377 - reqtarpit <search>
9378 - reqitarpit <search>
9379 - rspadd <string>
9380 - rspdel <search>
9381 - rspidel <search>
9382 - rspdeny <search>
9383 - rspideny <search>
9384 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9385 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9386
9387With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9388is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9389parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9390prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9391Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9392
9393 \t for a tab
9394 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9395 \n for a new line (LF)
9396 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9397 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9398 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9399 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9400 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9401
9402The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9403portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9404above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9405regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
94069 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9407is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9408
9409The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9410after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9411
9412Notes related to these keywords :
9413---------------------------------
9414 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9415 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9416 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9417
9418 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9419 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9420 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9421
9422 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9423 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9424 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9425 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9426 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9427
9428 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9429 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9430 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9431 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9432 useless headers before adding new ones.
9433
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009434 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009435 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9436
9437 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9438 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9439 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9440
9441 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9442 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009443 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009444
9445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094467. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9447----------------------------------
9448
9449Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9450client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9451The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9452these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9453but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9454data called patterns.
9455
9456
94577.1. ACL basics
9458---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009459
9460The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9461content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9462from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9463simple :
9464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009465 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009466 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009467 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9468 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009470The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9471adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009472
9473In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009475 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009476
9477This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9478Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9479and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009480an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9481conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9482as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9483are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009484
9485ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9486'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9487which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9488
9489There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9490performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009492The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9493specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9494this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009495methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9496ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009497
9498Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9499 - boolean
9500 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9501 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9502 - string
9503 - data block
9504
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009505Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9506converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9507would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9508The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9509which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9510
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009511Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9512keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9513fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9514which are summarized in the table below :
9515
9516 +---------------------+-----------------+
9517 | Sample or converter | Default |
9518 | output type | matching method |
9519 +---------------------+-----------------+
9520 | boolean | bool |
9521 +---------------------+-----------------+
9522 | integer | int |
9523 +---------------------+-----------------+
9524 | ip | ip |
9525 +---------------------+-----------------+
9526 | string | str |
9527 +---------------------+-----------------+
9528 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9529 +---------------------+-----------------+
9530
9531Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9532matching method, see below.
9533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009534The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9535 - boolean
9536 - integer or integer range
9537 - IP address / network
9538 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9539 - regular expression
9540 - hex block
9541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009542The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9543
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009544 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9545 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009546 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009547 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009548 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009549 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009550 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009552The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9553read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9554if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9555lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9556will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9557beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9558a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9559lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9560exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9561
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009562The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9563parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9564ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9565a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9566check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9567
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009568The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9569socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9570file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009572Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9573loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9574
9575 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9576
9577In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9578the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9579case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9580as well.
9581
9582The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9583sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9584do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9585methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9586is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9587obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9588followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9589default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9590that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9591string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9592
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009593The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9594By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9595string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9596resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9597server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9598waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9599flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9600function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009602There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9603sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9604be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009605
9606 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9607 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009608 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9609 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9610 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9611 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009612
9613 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9614 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009615 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009616
9617 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009618 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009619
9620 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009621 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009622
9623 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9624 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9625
9626 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9627 binary or string samples.
9628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009629 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9630 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009632 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9633 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9634 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009636 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9637 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009639 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9640 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009642 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9643 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009645 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9646 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009647 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009649 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9650 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9651 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009652
9653For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9654request, it is possible to do :
9655
9656 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9657
9658In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9659buffer, one would use the following acl :
9660
9661 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9662
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009663On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9664possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9665
9666 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009668All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9669criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9670method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9671to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9672criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9673the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009675If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009676the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9677For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009679 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9680 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9681 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9682 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009683
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009684
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009685The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9686types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9687combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9688brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9689default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009691 +-------------------------------------------------+
9692 | Input sample type |
9693 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009694 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009695 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9696 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9697 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009698 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009699 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009700 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009701 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009702 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009703 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009704 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009705 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009706 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009707 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009708 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009709 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009710 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009711 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009712 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009713 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009714 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009715 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009716 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009717 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009718 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009719 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9720 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9721 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009722
9723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097247.1.1. Matching booleans
9725------------------------
9726
9727In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9728Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9729When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9730that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9731
9732Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9733return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9734"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9735
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097377.1.2. Matching integers
9738------------------------
9739
9740Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9741enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9742to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9743
9744Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9745matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9746lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009747
9748For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9749unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9750representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9751
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009752As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9753two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9754instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9755ranges and operators.
9756
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009757For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009758operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9759Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9760of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009761
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009762Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009763
9764 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9765 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9766 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9767 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9768 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9769
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009770For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009771
9772 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9773
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009774This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9775
9776 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9777
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097797.1.3. Matching strings
9780-----------------------
9781
9782String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9783different forms :
9784
9785 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9786 patterns ;
9787
9788 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9789 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9790
9791 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9792 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9793
9794 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9795 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9796
9797 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9798 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9799 matches.
9800
9801 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9802 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9803 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009804
9805String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9806exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9807characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9808string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9809to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009810before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009811
9812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098137.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9814---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009815
9816Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9817they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9818possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9819passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9820the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009821the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9822match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009823
9824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098257.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9826-------------------------------------
9827
9828It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9829not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9830a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9831to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9832digits may be used upper or lower case.
9833
9834Example :
9835 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9836 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9837
9838
98397.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9840---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009841
9842IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9843netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9844within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009845host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009846difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9847at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9848does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9849parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009850
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009851IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9852Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9853trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9854IPv6 patterns.
9855
9856HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9857following situations :
9858 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9859 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9860 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9861 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9862 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9863 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9864 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9865 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9866 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9867 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009869
98707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9871----------------------------------
9872
9873Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9874combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9875
9876 - AND (implicit)
9877 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9878 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009880A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009882 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009884Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9885indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009887For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9888"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9889requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9890is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9891
9892 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9893 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9894 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9895 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9896
9897To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9898and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9899
9900 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9901 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9902 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9903 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9904
9905 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9906 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9907 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9908 use_backend www if host_www
9909
9910It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9911expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9912be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9913the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9914
9915 The following rule :
9916
9917 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9918 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9919
9920 Can also be written that way :
9921
9922 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9923
9924It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9925to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9926simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9927sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9928good use is the following :
9929
9930 With named ACLs :
9931
9932 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9933 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9934 monitor fail if site_dead
9935
9936 With anonymous ACLs :
9937
9938 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9939
9940See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9941
9942
99437.3. Fetching samples
9944---------------------
9945
9946Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9947against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9948sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9949ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9950of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9951available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9952
9953This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9954Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9955compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9956deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9957
9958The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9959matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9960method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9961indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9962
9963As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9964when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9965mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9966the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9967ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9968
9969Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9970multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9971when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9972incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9973are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9974is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9975all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9976
9977Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9978 - name
9979 - name(arg1)
9980 - name(arg1,arg2)
9981
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009982
99837.3.1. Converters
9984-----------------
9985
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009986Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9987of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9988is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9989was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9990has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9991unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9992
9993These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9994sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9995the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9996support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009998The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009999
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010000base64
10001 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10002 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10003 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10004
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010005hex
10006 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10007 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10008 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10009 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010010
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010011http_date([<offset>])
10012 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10013 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10014 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10015 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10016 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10017 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010018
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010019ipmask(<mask>)
10020 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10021 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10022 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10023 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10024
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010025language(<value>[,<default>])
10026 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10027 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10028 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10029 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10030 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10031 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10032 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10033 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10034 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10035 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10036 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10037 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010038
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010039 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010040
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010041 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10042 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010043
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010044 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10045 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10046 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10047 use_backend spanish if es
10048 use_backend french if fr
10049 use_backend english if en
10050 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010051
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010052lower
10053 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10054 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10055 type. The result is of type string.
10056
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010057map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10058map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10059map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10060 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10061 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10062 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10063 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10064 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10065 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10066 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10067 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010068
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010069 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10070 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10071 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010072
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010073 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10074 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010075
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010076 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10077 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10078 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10079 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010080 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10081 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010082 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10083 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10084 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10085 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10086 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10087 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10088 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10089 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10090 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10091 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10092 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10093 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10094 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10095 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010096
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010097 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10098 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10099 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10100 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10101 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010102
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010103 Example :
10104
10105 # this is a comment and is ignored
10106 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10107 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10108 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10109 | | | `---------- value
10110 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10111 | `---------------------------- key
10112 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10113
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010114upper
10115 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10116 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10117 type. The result is of type string.
10118
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010119
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200101207.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010121--------------------------------------------
10122
10123A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10124not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10125"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10126The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10127
10128always_false : boolean
10129 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10130 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10131
10132always_true : boolean
10133 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10134 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10135
10136avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010137 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010138 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10139 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10140 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10141 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10142 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10143 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10144 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10145 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10146 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10147 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10148 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10149 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10150 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010152be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010153 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10154 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10155 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10156 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10157 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010159be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10160 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10161 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10162 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10163 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10164 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10165 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010166
10167 Example :
10168 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10169 backend dynamic
10170 mode http
10171 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10172 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010174connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10175 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010176 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010177 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10178 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010179
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010180 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010181 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010182 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10183
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010184 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10185 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010186
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010187 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010188 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010189 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010190 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10191 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010192 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010193 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010194
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010195 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10196 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010197 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010198 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010199
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010200date([<offset>]) : integer
10201 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10202 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10203 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10204 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010205 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10206
10207 Example :
10208
10209 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10210 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010211
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010212env(<name>) : string
10213 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10214 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10215 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10216 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10217 certain way.
10218
10219 Examples :
10220 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10221 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10222
10223 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10224 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010226fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10227 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010228 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10229 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010230 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10231 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10232 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10233 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10234 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010236fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10237 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10238 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10239 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10240 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10241 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10242 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10243 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10244 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010245
10246 Example :
10247 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10248 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10249 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10250 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10251 frontend mail
10252 bind :25
10253 mode tcp
10254 maxconn 100
10255 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10256 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10257 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10258 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010259
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010260nbproc : integer
10261 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
10262 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
10263 and debugging purposes.
10264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010265nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10266 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10267 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10268 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010269 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10270 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10271 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010272
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010273proc : integer
10274 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
10275 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
10276 debugging purposes.
10277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010278queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010279 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10280 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10281 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010282 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10283 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10284 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10285 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10286 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10287
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010288rand([<range>]) : integer
10289 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10290 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10291 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10292 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10293 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010295srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10296 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10297 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10298 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10299 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10300 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10301 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10302 methods.
10303
10304srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10305 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10306 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10307 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10308 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10309 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10310 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10311 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10312
10313srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10314 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10315 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010316 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010317 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10318 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10319 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10320 overloading servers).
10321
10322 Example :
10323 # Redirect to a separate back
10324 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10325 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10326 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10327
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010328stopping : boolean
10329 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
10330 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
10331 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
10332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010333table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10334 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10335 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10336
10337table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10338 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10339 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10340 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10341
10342
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200103437.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010344----------------------------------
10345
10346The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10347closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10348methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10349sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10350TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010351the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10352counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10353"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010354argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10355the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10356this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010357
10358be_id : integer
10359 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10360 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10361
10362dst : ip
10363 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10364 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10365 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10366 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10367 RFC 4291.
10368
10369dst_conn : integer
10370 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10371 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10372 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10373 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10374 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10375 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10376 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10377 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010379dst_port : integer
10380 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10381 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10382 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10383 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10384 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10385 an HTTP header.
10386
10387fe_id : integer
10388 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10389 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10390 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10391
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010392sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010393sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10394sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10395sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010396 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10397 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10398 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10399
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010400sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010401sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10402sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10403sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010404 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10405 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10406 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10407
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010408sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010409sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10410sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10411sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010412 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10413 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010414 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10415 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10416 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010417
10418 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10419 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010420 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10421 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10422 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010423 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10424 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10425
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010426sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010427sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10428sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10429sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010430 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10431 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10432
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010433sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010434sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10435sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10436sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010437 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10438 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10439 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10440
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010441sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010442sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10443sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10444sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010445 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10446 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10447 See also src_conn_rate.
10448
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010449sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010450sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10451sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10452sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010453 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010454 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010455
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010456sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010457sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10458sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10459sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010460 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10461 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10462 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010463 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10464 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10465 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010466
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010467sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010468sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10469sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10470sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010471 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10472 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10473 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10474
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010475sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010476sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10477sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10478sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010479 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10480 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10481 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10482 src_http_err_rate.
10483
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010484sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010485sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10486sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10487sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010488 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10489 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10490 src_http_req_cnt.
10491
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010492sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010493sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10494sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10495sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010496 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10497 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10498 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10499 src_http_req_rate.
10500
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010501sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010502sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10503sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10504sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010505 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010506 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10507 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10508 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10509 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010510
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010511 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10512 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010513 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10514
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010515sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010516sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10517sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10518sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010519 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10520 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10521 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010522
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010523sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010524sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10525sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10526sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010527 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10528 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10529 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010530
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010531sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010532sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10533sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10534sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010535 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10536 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10537 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10538 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010539 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010540 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10541
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010542sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010543sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10544sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10545sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010546 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10547 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10548 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10549 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10550 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010551 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010552
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010553sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010554sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10555sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10556sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010557 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10558 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10559 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10560
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010561sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010562sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10563sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10564sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010565 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10566 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010567 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010568 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10569 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010570 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10571 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10572 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010574so_id : integer
10575 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10576 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10577 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010579src : ip
10580 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10581 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10582 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10583 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10584 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10585 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10586 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010587
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010588 Example:
10589 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10590 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010592src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10593 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10594 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10595 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010596 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010598src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10599 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10600 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010601 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010602 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010604src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10605 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10606 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10607 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10608 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10609 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10610 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010611
10612 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10613 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10614 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10615 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010616 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010617 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10618 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010620src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010621 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010622 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010623 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010624 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010626src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010627 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010628 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10629 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010630 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010632src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10633 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10634 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10635 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010636 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010638src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010639 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010640 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010641 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010642 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010644src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010645 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010646 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010647 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10648 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010649 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10650 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10651 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010653src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10654 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10655 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010656 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010657 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010658 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010660src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10661 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10662 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10663 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10664 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010665 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010667src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10668 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10669 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10670 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010671 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010673src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10674 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10675 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10676 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010677 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010678 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010680src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10681 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10682 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10683 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010684 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010685 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10686 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010687
10688 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010689 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010690 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010692src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010693 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
10694 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
10695 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
10696 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
10697 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010699src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010700 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
10701 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10702 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
10703 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10704 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010706src_port : integer
10707 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10708 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10709 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10710 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010712src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10713 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010714 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10715 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10716 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010717 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010719src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10720 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10721 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10722 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10723 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010724 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010726src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10727 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10728 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10729 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10730 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10731 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10732 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10733 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10734 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010735
10736 Example :
10737 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10738 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10739 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10740 listen ssh
10741 bind :22
10742 mode tcp
10743 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010744 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010745 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010746 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010748srv_id : integer
10749 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10750 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10751 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010752
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010753
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200107547.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010755----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010757The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10758closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10759when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10760usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010761future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010762
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010763ssl_bc : boolean
10764 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10765 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10766 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10767
10768ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10769 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10770 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10771
10772ssl_bc_cipher : string
10773 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10774 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10775
10776ssl_bc_protocol : string
10777 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10778 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10779
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010780ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010781 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010782 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10783 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010784
10785ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10786 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10787 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10788 if session was reused or not.
10789
10790ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10791 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10792 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010794ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10795 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10796 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10797 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10798 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10799 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010801ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10802 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10803 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10804 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10805 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010806
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010807ssl_c_der : binary
10808 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
10809 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10810 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010812ssl_c_err : integer
10813 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10814 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10815 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10816 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10817 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010819ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10820 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10821 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10822 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10823 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10824 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10825 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10826 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10827 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010829ssl_c_key_alg : string
10830 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10831 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10832 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010834ssl_c_notafter : string
10835 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10836 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10837 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010839ssl_c_notbefore : string
10840 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10841 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10842 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010844ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10845 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10846 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10847 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10848 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10849 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10850 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10851 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10852 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010854ssl_c_serial : binary
10855 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10856 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10857 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010859ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10860 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10861 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10862 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau9fe4cb62014-07-02 19:01:22 +020010863 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
10864 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
10865
10866 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010868ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10869 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10870 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10871 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010873ssl_c_used : boolean
10874 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10875 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010877ssl_c_verify : integer
10878 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10879 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10880 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10881 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010883ssl_c_version : integer
10884 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10885 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010886
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010887ssl_f_der : binary
10888 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
10889 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10890 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010892ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10893 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10894 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10895 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10896 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010897 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010898 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10899 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10900 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010902ssl_f_key_alg : string
10903 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10904 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10905 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010907ssl_f_notafter : string
10908 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10909 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10910 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010912ssl_f_notbefore : string
10913 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10914 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10915 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010917ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10918 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10919 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10920 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10921 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10922 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10923 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10924 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10925 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010927ssl_f_serial : binary
10928 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10929 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10930 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010931
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010932ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10933 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10934 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10935 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010937ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10938 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10939 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10940 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010942ssl_f_version : integer
10943 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10944 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10945
10946ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010947 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10948 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10949 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010951 Example :
10952 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10953 listen http-https
10954 bind :80
10955 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10956 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10957
10958ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10959 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10960 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10961
10962ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010963 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010964 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10965 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10966 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10967 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10968 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10969 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10970 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10971 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010973ssl_fc_cipher : string
10974 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10975 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010977ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010978 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10979 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010980 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10981 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10982 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10983 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010985ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10986 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010987 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10988 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10989 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10990 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010992ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010993 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010994 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10995 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10996 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10997 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10998 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10999 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11000 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011002ssl_fc_protocol : string
11003 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11004 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011005
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011006ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011007 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011008 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11009 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011011ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11012 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11013 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11014 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11015 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011017ssl_fc_sni : string
11018 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11019 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11020 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11021 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11022 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11023
11024 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11025 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11026 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011027 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11028 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011030 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011031 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11032 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011034ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11035 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11036 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011037
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011038
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200110397.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011040------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011042Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11043sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11044only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11045For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11046be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11047can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11048sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11049for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11050content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011052payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11053 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11054 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11055 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011057payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11058 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11059 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11060 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011062req.len : integer
11063req_len : integer (deprecated)
11064 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11065 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11066 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11067 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11068 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11069 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11070 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11071 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011073req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11074 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011075 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11076 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11077 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11078 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011080 ACL alternatives :
11081 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011083req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11084 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11085 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11086 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11087 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011089 ACL alternatives :
11090 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011092 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011094req.proto_http : boolean
11095req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11096 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11097 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11098 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11099 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11100 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11101 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11102 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011104 Example:
11105 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11106 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11107 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011108 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011110req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11111rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11112 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11113 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11114 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11115 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11116 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11117 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11118 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011120 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11121 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11122 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11123 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11124 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11125 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011127 ACL derivatives :
11128 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011130 Example :
11131 listen tse-farm
11132 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11133 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11134 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11135 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11136 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11137 persist rdp-cookie
11138 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11139 # This is only useful makes sense if
11140 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11141 stick-table type string size 204800
11142 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11143 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11144 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011146 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11147 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011149req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11150rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11151 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11152 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11153 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11154 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011156 ACL derivatives :
11157 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011159req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11160req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11161 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11162 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11163 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11164 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11165 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11166 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11167 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011169req.ssl_sni : string
11170req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11171 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11172 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11173 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11174 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11175 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11176 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11177 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11178 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11179 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11180 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11181 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11182 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011184 ACL derivatives :
11185 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011187 Examples :
11188 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11189 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11190 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11191 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11192 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011194res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11195rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11196 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11197 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11198 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11199 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11200 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11201 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11202 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011204req.ssl_ver : integer
11205req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11206 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11207 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11208 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11209 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11210 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11211 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11212 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11213 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11214 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011216 ACL derivatives :
11217 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011218
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011219res.len : integer
11220 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11221 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11222 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11223 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11224 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11225 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11226 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11227 content inspection.
11228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011229res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11230 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011231 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11232 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11233 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11234 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011236res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11237 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11238 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11239 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11240 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011242 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011244wait_end : boolean
11245 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11246 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11247 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11248 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11249 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11250 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11251 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11252 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011254 Examples :
11255 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11256 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11257 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011259 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11260 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11261 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11262 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11263 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11264 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11265 tcp-request content reject
11266
11267
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200112687.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011269--------------------------------------
11270
11271It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11272This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11273data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11274its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11275HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11276content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11277to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11278more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11279response are indexed.
11280
11281base : string
11282 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11283 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11284 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11285 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11286 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11287 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11288 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11289 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11290
11291 ACL derivatives :
11292 base : exact string match
11293 base_beg : prefix match
11294 base_dir : subdir match
11295 base_dom : domain match
11296 base_end : suffix match
11297 base_len : length match
11298 base_reg : regex match
11299 base_sub : substring match
11300
11301base32 : integer
11302 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11303 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11304 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11305 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11306
11307base32+src : binary
11308 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11309 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11310 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11311 per-URL counters.
11312
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011313capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11314 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11315 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11316 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11317
11318capture.req.method : string
11319 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11320 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11321 because it's allocated.
11322
11323capture.req.uri : string
11324 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11325 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11326 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11327 allocated.
11328
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011329capture.req.ver : string
11330 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11331 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11332 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11333
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011334capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11335 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11336 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11337 The first entry is an index of 0.
11338 See also: "capture response header"
11339
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011340capture.res.ver : string
11341 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11342 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11343 persistent flag.
11344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011345req.cook([<name>]) : string
11346cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11347 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11348 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11349 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11350 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11351 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11352 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11353 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11354 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11355
11356 ACL derivatives :
11357 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11358 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11359 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11360 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11361 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11362 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11363 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11364 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011366req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11367cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11368 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11369 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011371req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11372cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11373 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11374 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11375 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11376 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011378cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11379 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11380 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11381 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11382 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11383 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11384 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11385 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11386 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11387 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11388 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011390hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11391 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11392 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11393 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11394 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011395 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011397req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11398 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11399 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11400 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11401 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11402 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11403 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11404 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11405 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011407req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11408 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11409 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11410 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11411 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011413req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11414 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11415 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11416 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11417 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11418 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11419 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11420 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11421 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11422 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11423 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11424 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011426 ACL derivatives :
11427 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11428 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11429 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11430 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11431 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11432 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11433 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11434 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11435
11436req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11437hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11438 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11439 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11440 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11441 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11442 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11443 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11444 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11445 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11446 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11447
11448req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11449hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11450 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11451 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11452 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11453 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11454 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11455 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11456 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11457 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11458
11459req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11460hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11461 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11462 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11463 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11464 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11465 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11466 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11467 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11468
11469http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11470 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11471 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11472 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11473 basic auth is supported.
11474
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011475http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11476 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11477 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11478 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11479 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011480 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11481 basic auth is supported.
11482
11483 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011484 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11485 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11486 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11487 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011488
11489http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011490 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11491 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011492 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11493 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011495method : integer + string
11496 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11497 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11498 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11499 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11500 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11501 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11502 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011504 ACL derivatives :
11505 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011507 Example :
11508 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11509 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11510 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011512path : string
11513 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11514 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11515 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11516 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11517 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11518 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11519 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011521 ACL derivatives :
11522 path : exact string match
11523 path_beg : prefix match
11524 path_dir : subdir match
11525 path_dom : domain match
11526 path_end : suffix match
11527 path_len : length match
11528 path_reg : regex match
11529 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011531req.ver : string
11532req_ver : string (deprecated)
11533 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11534 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11535 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011537 ACL derivatives :
11538 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011540res.comp : boolean
11541 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11542 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11543 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011545res.comp_algo : string
11546 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11547 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11548 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011550res.cook([<name>]) : string
11551scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11552 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11553 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11554 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011556 ACL derivatives :
11557 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011559res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11560scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11561 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11562 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11563 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011565res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11566scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11567 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11568 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11569 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011571res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11572 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11573 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11574 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11575 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11576 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11577 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11578 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11579 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11580 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011582res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11583 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11584 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11585 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11586 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11587 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011589res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11590shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11591 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11592 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11593 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11594 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11595 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11596 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11597 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11598 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011600 ACL derivatives :
11601 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11602 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11603 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11604 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11605 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11606 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11607 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11608 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11609
11610res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11611shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11612 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11613 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11614 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11615 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11616 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011618res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11619shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11620 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11621 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11622 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11623 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11624 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11625 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011627res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11628shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11629 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11630 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11631 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11632 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11633 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11634 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011636res.ver : string
11637resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11638 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11639 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011641 ACL derivatives :
11642 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011644set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11645 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11646 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11647 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11648 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011650 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11651 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011653 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011655status : integer
11656 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11657 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11658 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011660url : string
11661 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11662 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11663 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11664 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11665 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11666 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11667 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011669 ACL derivatives :
11670 url : exact string match
11671 url_beg : prefix match
11672 url_dir : subdir match
11673 url_dom : domain match
11674 url_end : suffix match
11675 url_len : length match
11676 url_reg : regex match
11677 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011679url_ip : ip
11680 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11681 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11682 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11683 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11684 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11685 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11686 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011688url_port : integer
11689 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11690 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11691 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11692 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011694urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11695url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11696 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11697 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11698 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11699 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11700 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11701 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11702 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11703 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11704 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011706 ACL derivatives :
11707 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11708 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11709 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11710 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11711 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11712 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11713 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11714 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011715
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011717 Example :
11718 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11719 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11720 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11721 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011723urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11724 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11725 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11726 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011727
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117297.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011730---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011731
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011732Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11733every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011734order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011736ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11737---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011738FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011739HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011740HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11741HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011742HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11743HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11744HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11745HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11746LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011747METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11748METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11749METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11750METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11751METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11752METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011753RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011754REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011755TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011756WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11757---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011758
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117608. Logging
11761----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011762
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011763One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11764provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11765very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11766provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11767state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011768to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011769headers.
11770
11771In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11772about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11773send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11774
11775 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11776 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11777 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11778 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11779 at the termination.
11780
11781The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11782allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11783as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11784while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11785real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11786delay.
11787
11788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117898.1. Log levels
11790---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011791
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011792TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011793source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011794HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11795in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11796track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11797syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11798about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011799
11800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118018.2. Log formats
11802----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011803
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011804HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011805and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11806slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11807options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011808
11809 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11810 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11811 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11812 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11813 extents.
11814
11815 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11816 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11817 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11818 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11819 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11820
11821 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11822 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11823 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11824 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11825 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11826
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011827 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11828 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11829 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11830 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11831
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011832 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11833
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011834Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11835specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11836field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11837servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11838always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11839identifier.
11840
11841Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11842 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11843 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11844 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11845 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11846
11847
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118488.2.1. Default log format
11849-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011850
11851This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11852as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11853format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11854
11855 Example :
11856 listen www
11857 mode http
11858 log global
11859 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11860
11861 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11862 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11863 (www/HTTP)
11864
11865 Field Format Extract from the example above
11866 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11867 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11868 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11869 4 'to' to
11870 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11871 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11872
11873Detailed fields description :
11874 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11875 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11876 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11877 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11878 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11879 and processed the connection.
11880 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11881
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011882In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11883"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11884connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11885
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011886It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11887will eventually disappear.
11888
11889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118908.2.2. TCP log format
11891---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011892
11893The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11894is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11895information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11896counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11897emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11898environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11899the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11900sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011901specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11902not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11903fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11904marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011905
11906 Example :
11907 frontend fnt
11908 mode tcp
11909 option tcplog
11910 log global
11911 default_backend bck
11912
11913 backend bck
11914 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11915
11916 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11917 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11918 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11919
11920 Field Format Extract from the example above
11921 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11922 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11923 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11924 4 frontend_name fnt
11925 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11926 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11927 7 bytes_read* 212
11928 8 termination_state --
11929 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11930 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11931
11932Detailed fields description :
11933 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011934 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11935 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11936 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11937 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11938 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011939
11940 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011941 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11942 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11943 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011944
11945 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11946 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11947 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11948 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11949
11950 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11951 and processed the connection.
11952
11953 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11954 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11955 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11956 applications.
11957
11958 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11959 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11960 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11961 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11962 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11963
11964 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11965 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11966 See "Timers" below for more details.
11967
11968 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11969 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11970 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11971 "Timers" below for more details.
11972
11973 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011974 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011975 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11976 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11977 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11978 details.
11979
11980 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11981 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11982 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11983 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11984 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11985
11986 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11987 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11988 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11989 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11990 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11991 for more details.
11992
11993 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011994 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011995 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11996 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11997 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011998 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011999
12000 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12001 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12002 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12003 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12004 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12005 caused by a denial of service attack.
12006
12007 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12008 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12009 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12010 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12011 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12012 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12013 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12014 denial of service attack.
12015
12016 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12017 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12018 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12019 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12020 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12021 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12022 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12023 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12024 be processed than on other servers.
12025
12026 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12027 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12028 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12029 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12030 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12031 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12032 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12033 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12034 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12035 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12036 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12037 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12038 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12039
12040 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12041 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12042 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12043 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12044 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12045 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12046 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12047 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12048
12049 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12050 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12051 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12052 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12053 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12054 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12055 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12056 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12057 occurs.
12058
12059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120608.2.3. HTTP log format
12061----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012062
12063The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12064is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12065the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12066are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12067emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12068generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12069"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12070which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012071frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12072is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012073
12074Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12075slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12076with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12077
12078 Example :
12079 frontend http-in
12080 mode http
12081 option httplog
12082 log global
12083 default_backend bck
12084
12085 backend static
12086 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12087
12088 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12089 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12090 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012091 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012092
12093 Field Format Extract from the example above
12094 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12095 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12096 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12097 4 frontend_name http-in
12098 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12099 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12100 7 status_code 200
12101 8 bytes_read* 2750
12102 9 captured_request_cookie -
12103 10 captured_response_cookie -
12104 11 termination_state ----
12105 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12106 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12107 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12108 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12109 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012110
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012111
12112Detailed fields description :
12113 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012114 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12115 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12116 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12117 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12118 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012119
12120 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012121 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12122 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12123 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012124
12125 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12126 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12127 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12128 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12129 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12130
12131 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12132 and processed the connection.
12133
12134 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12135 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12136 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12137
12138 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12139 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12140 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12141 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12142 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12143 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12144
12145 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12146 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12147 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12148 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12149 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12150 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12151
12152 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12153 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12154 See "Timers" below for more details.
12155
12156 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12157 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12158 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12159 below for more details.
12160
12161 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12162 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12163 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12164 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12165 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12166 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12167 for more details.
12168
12169 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012170 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012171 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12172 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12173 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12174 details.
12175
12176 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12177 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12178 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12179
12180 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12181 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12182 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12183 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12184 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12185 overflowing.
12186
12187 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12188 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12189 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12190 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12191 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12192 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12193 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12194 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12195
12196 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12197 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12198 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12199 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12200 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12201 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12202 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12203 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12204
12205 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12206 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12207 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12208 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12209 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12210 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12211 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12212
12213 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012214 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012215 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12216 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12217 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012218 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012219 system.
12220
12221 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12222 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12223 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12224 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12225 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12226 caused by a denial of service attack.
12227
12228 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12229 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12230 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12231 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12232 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12233 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12234 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12235 denial of service attack.
12236
12237 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12238 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12239 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12240 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12241 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12242 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12243 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12244 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12245 processed than on other servers.
12246
12247 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12248 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12249 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12250 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12251 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12252 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12253 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12254 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12255 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12256 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12257 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12258 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12259 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12260
12261 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12262 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12263 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12264 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12265 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12266 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12267 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12268 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12269
12270 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12271 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12272 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12273 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12274 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12275 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12276 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12277 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12278 occurs.
12279
12280 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12281 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12282 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12283 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12284 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12285 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12286 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12287 cookies" below for more details.
12288
12289 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12290 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12291 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12292 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12293 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12294 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12295 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12296 and cookies" below for more details.
12297
12298 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12299 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12300 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12301 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12302 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12303 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12304 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12305 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12306
12307
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200123088.2.4. Custom log format
12309------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012310
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012311The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012312mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012313
12314HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12315Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12316separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12317prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12318
12319Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12320variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12321string formats ("Q").
12322
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012323If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012324as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012325less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12326the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12327
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012328Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012329In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012330in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012331
12332Flags are :
12333 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012334 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012335
12336 Example:
12337
12338 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12339 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12340
12341At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12342
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012343 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12344 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012345
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012346the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012347
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012348 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012349 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012350 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012351
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012352and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12353
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012354 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012355 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12356
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012357Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12358
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012359 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012360 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012361 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12362 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12363 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012364 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12365 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12366 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012367 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012368 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012369 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012370 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012371 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012372 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012373 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12374 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012375 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012376 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12377 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012378 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012379 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12380 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012381 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12382 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12383 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012384 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012385 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12386 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012387 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012388 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12389 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12390 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012391 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012392 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12393 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12394 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12395 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreauc3453d52015-08-09 10:56:35 +020012396 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012397 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012398 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012399 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012400 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012401 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012402 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12403 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12404 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012405 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012406 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12407 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012408 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012409 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012410 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012411 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012412
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012413 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012414
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012415
124168.2.5. Error log format
12417-----------------------
12418
12419When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12420protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12421By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12422"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12423will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12424logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12425
12426The format looks like this :
12427
12428 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12429 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12430 Connection error during SSL handshake
12431
12432 Field Format Extract from the example above
12433 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12434 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12435 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12436 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12437 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12438
12439These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12440failures.
12441
12442
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124438.3. Advanced logging options
12444-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012445
12446Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12447just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12448options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12449for more information about their usage.
12450
12451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124528.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12453------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012454
12455It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12456haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12457commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12458monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12459ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12460
12461 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12462 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12463 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12464 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12465
12466 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12467 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12468 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012469 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012470 such as other load-balancers.
12471
12472 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12473 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12474 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12475
12476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124778.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12478----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012479
12480The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12481what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12482or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12483"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12484just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12485log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12486after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12487is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12488with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12489with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12490
12491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124928.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12493------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012494
12495Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12496for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12497"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12498retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12499raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12500a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12501file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12502you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12503"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12504
12505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12507--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012508
12509Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12510multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12511them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12512"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12513logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12514error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12515and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12516too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12517useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12518alternative.
12519
12520
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125218.4. Timing events
12522------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012523
12524Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12525reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12526the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12527frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12528mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12529
12530 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12531 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12532 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12533 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12534 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12535
12536 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12537 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12538 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12539 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12540 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12541
12542 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12543 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12544 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12545 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12546 connection never established.
12547
12548 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12549 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12550 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12551 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12552 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12553 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12554 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12555 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12556 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12557 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12558 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12559
12560 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12561 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12562 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12563 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012564 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012565
12566 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12567
12568 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12569 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12570 negative.
12571
12572These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12573protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12574that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012575due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012576close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12577session has been aborted on timeout.
12578
12579Most common cases :
12580
12581 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12582 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12583 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12584 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12585 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12586 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12587 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12588 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12589 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012590 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12591 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12592 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012593
12594 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12595 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12596 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12597 of ms on remote networks.
12598
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012599 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12600 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12601 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012602
12603 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12604 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12605 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12606 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12607 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12608 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12609 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12610 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12611 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12612 to the server until another one is released.
12613
12614Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12615
12616 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12617 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12618 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12619
12620 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12621 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12622 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12623
12624 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12625 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12626 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12627 flags.
12628
12629 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12630 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12631 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12632 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12633 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12634 the client connection was maintained open.
12635
12636 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012637 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012638 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12639 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12640
12641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126428.5. Session state at disconnection
12643-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012644
12645TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12646"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
126472-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12648each of which has a special meaning :
12649
12650 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12651 session to terminate :
12652
12653 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12654
12655 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12656 server explicitly refused it.
12657
12658 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12659 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12660 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12661 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012662 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12663
12664 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12665 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012666
12667 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12668 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12669 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12670 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12671 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12672
12673 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12674 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12675 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12676 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12677 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12678
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012679 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12680 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12681
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012682 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12683 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12684 backup connections when going up.
12685
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012686 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12687
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012688 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12689 send or receive data.
12690
12691 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12692 send or receive data.
12693
12694 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12695 with nothing left in the buffers.
12696
12697 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12698
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012699 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012700 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12701
12702 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12703 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12704 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12705 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12706 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12707
12708 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12709 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12710
12711 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12712 server (HTTP only).
12713
12714 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12715
12716 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12717 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12718 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12719
12720 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12721 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12722 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12723
12724 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12725
12726 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12727 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12728
12729 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12730 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12731 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12732
12733 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12734 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012735 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12736 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012737
12738 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12739 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12740 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12741 another server.
12742
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012743 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012744 server.
12745
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012746 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12747 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12748 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12749 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12750
12751 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12752 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12753 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12754 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12755
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012756 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12757 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12758 "use-server" rule).
12759
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012760 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12761
12762 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12763 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12764
12765 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12766
12767 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12768 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12769 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12770
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012771 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12772 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012773 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012774 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12775 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12776
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012777 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12778
12779 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12780 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12781
12782 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12783
12784 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12785
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012786The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12787was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012788helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12789starvation, attacks, etc...
12790
12791The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12792alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12793easier finding and understanding.
12794
12795 Flags Reason
12796
12797 -- Normal termination.
12798
12799 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12800 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12801 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12802 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12803
12804 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12805 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12806 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12807 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12808 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12809 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012810
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012811 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12812 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012813 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012814
12815 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12816 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12817 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12818
12819 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12820 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12821 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12822 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12823 the server takes too long to respond.
12824
12825 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12826 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12827 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12828 long a time to respond.
12829
12830 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12831 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12832 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12833 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012834 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
12835 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012836
12837 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12838 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12839 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12840 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12841 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012842 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012843 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
12844 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
12845 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
12846 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
12847 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
12848 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
12849 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
12850 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
12851 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
12852 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
12853 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
12854 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012855
12856 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12857 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012858 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12859 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12860 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12861 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012862
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012863 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12864 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12865
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012866 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012867 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12868 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12869 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12870 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12871 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12872
12873 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12874 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12875 503 or 504 here.
12876
12877 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12878 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12879 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12880 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12881 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12882
12883 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12884 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012885 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012886 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12887 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12888
12889 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12890 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12891 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12892 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12893 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12894 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12895 between haproxy and the server.
12896
12897 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12898 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12899 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12900 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12901 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12902 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12903 solution is to fix the application.
12904
12905 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12906 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12907 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12908 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12909 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12910 external attacks.
12911
12912 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12913 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012914 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012915 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12916 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12917
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012918 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12919 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12920 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012921 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12922 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012923
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012924 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12925 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12926 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12927 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012928 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12929 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12930 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12931 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12932 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012933
12934 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12935 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12936 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12937 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12938
12939 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12940 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12941 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12942 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12943
12944 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12945 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12946 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12947 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12948
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012949The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12950persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12951important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12952re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12953
12954 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12955
12956 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12957 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12958 set on a GET request.
12959
12960 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12961 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012962 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012963 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12964
12965 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12966 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12967 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12968
12969 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12970 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12971 already got a cookie.
12972
12973 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12974 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12975 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12976 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12977 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12978
12979 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12980 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12981 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12982
12983 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12984 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12985 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12986
12987 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12988 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12989
12990 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12991 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12992 then advertised in the response.
12993
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129958.6. Non-printable characters
12996-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012997
12998In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12999consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
13000converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
13001prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
13002being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
13003escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
13004is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
13005'}' when logging headers.
13006
13007Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
13008issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
13009containing spaces is "User-Agent".
13010
13011Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
13012the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
13013performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13014
13015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130168.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13017---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013018
13019Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13020achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013021section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013022cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13023the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13024the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013025locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013026not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13027user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13028a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13029wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13030
13031 Examples :
13032 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13033 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13034
13035 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13036 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13037
13038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130398.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13040---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013041
13042Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13043proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13044the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13045server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13046
13047Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13048response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013049section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013050
13051It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013052time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13053appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013054are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13055and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13056follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13057request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13058in the logs.
13059
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013060As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13061frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13062an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13063
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013064 Example :
13065 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13066 listen proxy-out
13067 mode http
13068 option httplog
13069 option logasap
13070 log global
13071 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13072
13073 # log the name of the virtual server
13074 capture request header Host len 20
13075
13076 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13077 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13078
13079 # log the beginning of the referrer
13080 capture request header Referer len 20
13081
13082 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13083 capture response header Server len 20
13084
13085 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13086 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13087
13088 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13089 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13090
13091 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13092 capture response header Via len 20
13093
13094 # log the URL location during a redirection
13095 capture response header Location len 20
13096
13097 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13098 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13099 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13100 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13101 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13102
13103 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13104 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13105 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13106 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013107 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013108
13109 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13110 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13111 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13112 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13113 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013114 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013115
13116
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131178.9. Examples of logs
13118---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013119
13120These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13121them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13122reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13123
13124 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13125 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13126 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13127
13128 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13129 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13130
13131 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13132 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13133 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13134
13135 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13136 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13137
13138 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13139 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13140 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13141
13142 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013143 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013144 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13145 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13146
13147 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13148 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13149 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13150
13151 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13152 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013153 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013154 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13155 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13156 to return the 502 and not the server.
13157
13158 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013159 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013160
13161 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13162 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13163 Nothing was sent to any server.
13164
13165 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13166 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13167
13168 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13169 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13170 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13171 send a 408 return code to the client.
13172
13173 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13174 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13175
13176 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13177 5 seconds ("c----").
13178
13179 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13180 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013181 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013182
13183 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013184 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013185 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13186 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13187 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13188 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13189 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013190
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013191
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131929. Statistics and monitoring
13193----------------------------
13194
13195It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13196mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13197CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13198Unix socket.
13199
13200
132019.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013202---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013203
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013204The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013205page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13206begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13207represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13208use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13209('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13210(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13211text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13212do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13213use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013214
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013215In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13216that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13217S (Servers).
13218
13219 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13220 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13221 any name for server/listener)
13222 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13223 number queued without a server assigned.
13224 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13225 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13226 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13227 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13228 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13229 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13230 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13231 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13232 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13233 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13234 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13235 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13236 "option checkcache".
13237 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13238 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13239 - read error from the client
13240 - client timeout
13241 - client closed connection
13242 - various bad requests from the client.
13243 - request was tarpitted.
13244 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13245 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13246 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13247 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13248 active servers).
13249 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13250 Some other errors are:
13251 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13252 - failure applying filters to the response.
13253 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13254 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13255 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13256 switched away from.
13257 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Pavlos Parissisac372e12015-05-02 20:30:44 +020013258 18. weight [..BS]: total weight (backend), server weight (server)
13259 19. act [..BS]: number of active servers (backend), server is active (server)
13260 20. bck [..BS]: number of backup servers (backend), server is backup (server)
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013261 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13262 the server is up.)
13263 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13264 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13265 counters for each server.
13266 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13267 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13268 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13269 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13270 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13271 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13272 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13273 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13274 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13275 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13276 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13277 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13278 of times that server was selected.
13279 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13280 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13281 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13282 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13283 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13284 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013285 UNK -> unknown
13286 INI -> initializing
13287 SOCKERR -> socket error
13288 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harveycac41222015-04-16 11:13:21 -080013289 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013290 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13291 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13292 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13293 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13294 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13295 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13296 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13297 disable-on-404
13298 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13299 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13300 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013301 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13302 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13303 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13304 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13305 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13306 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13307 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13308 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13309 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13310 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13311 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13312 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13313 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13314 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13315 (inc. in eresp)
13316 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13317 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13318 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13319 (CPU/BW limit)
13320 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13321 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13322 server/backend
13323 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13324 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13325 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13326 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13327 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13328 (0 for TCP)
13329 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13330 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013331
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013332
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133339.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013334-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013335
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013336The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13337necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13338A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13339issuing commands by hand :
13340
13341 global
13342 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13343 stats timeout 2m
13344
13345It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13346the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13347never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13348situations :
13349
13350 global
13351 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13352 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13353 stats timeout 2m
13354
13355To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13356swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13357to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13358syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13359
13360 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13361 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13362
13363The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13364script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13365for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13366
13367The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13368that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13369editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13370(eg: watch a counter).
13371
13372The socket supports two operation modes :
13373 - interactive
13374 - non-interactive
13375
13376The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13377this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13378sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13379mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13380commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13381example :
13382
13383 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13384
13385The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13386entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13387for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13388sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13389"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13390after processing the last command of the same line.
13391
13392For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13393"prompt" command :
13394
13395 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13396 prompt
13397 > show info
13398 ...
13399 >
13400
13401Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13402delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13403that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13404parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013405
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013406It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13407on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13408own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013409
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013410The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13411If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13412all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13413it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13414
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013415add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013416 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13417 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13418 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13419 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013420
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013421add map <map> <key> <value>
13422 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13423 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013424 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13425 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13426 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013427
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013428clear counters
13429 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13430 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13431 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13432 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13433 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13434
13435clear counters all
13436 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13437 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13438 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13439
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013440clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013441 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13442 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13443 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013444
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013445clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013446 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13447 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13448 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013449
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013450clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13451 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13452
13453 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13454 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13455 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13456 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13457 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13458 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13459
13460 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13461
13462 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13463 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13464 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13465 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13466 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13467 the ACLs :
13468
13469 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13470 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13471 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13472 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13473 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13474 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13475
13476 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013477 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13478 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013479
13480 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013481 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013482 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013483 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13484 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13485 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13486 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013487
13488 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13489
13490 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013491 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013492 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13493 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013494 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13495 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13496 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013497
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013498del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13499 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013500 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13501 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13502 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13503 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013504
13505del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013506 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013507 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13508 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13509 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13510 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013511
13512disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013513 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13514
13515 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13516 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13517 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13518 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13519 re-enabled using enable agent.
13520
13521 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13522 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13523 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13524 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13525 otherwise unchanged.
13526
13527 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13528 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13529 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13530
13531 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13532 level "admin".
13533
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013534disable frontend <frontend>
13535 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13536 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13537 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13538 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13539 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13540 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13541 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13542 on the stats page.
13543
13544 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13545 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13546
13547 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13548 level "admin".
13549
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013550disable health <backend>/<server>
13551 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13552 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13553 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13554 agent check forces it down.
13555
13556 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13557 level "admin".
13558
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013559disable server <backend>/<server>
13560 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13561 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13562 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13563 during the maintenance.
13564
13565 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13566 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13567
13568 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013569 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013570
13571 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13572 level "admin".
13573
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013574enable agent <backend>/<server>
13575 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13576
13577 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13578 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13579
13580 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13581 level "admin".
13582
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013583enable frontend <frontend>
13584 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13585 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13586 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13587 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13588 which was disabled.
13589
13590 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13591 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13592
13593 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13594 level "admin".
13595
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013596enable health <backend>/<server>
13597 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13598 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13599
13600 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13601 level "admin".
13602
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013603enable server <backend>/<server>
13604 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13605 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13606
13607 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013608 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013609
13610 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13611 level "admin".
13612
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013613get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013614get acl <acl> <value>
13615 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13616 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13617 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13618 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13619 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013620
13621 The first two words are:
13622
13623 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13624 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13625 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13626
13627 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13628
13629 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13630
13631 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13632
13633 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13634 interpretation of the case.
13635
13636 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13637 useful with regular expressions.
13638
13639 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13640 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13641
13642 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13643 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13644 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13645
13646 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13647
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013648get weight <backend>/<server>
13649 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13650 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13651 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13652 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13653 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013654 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013655
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013656help
13657 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13658 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013659
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013660prompt
13661 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13662 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13663 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13664 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13665 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13666 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13667 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13668 command.
13669
13670quit
13671 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013672
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013673set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013674 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13675 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13676 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013677
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013678set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013679 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13680 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13681 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13682 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13683 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013684 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13685 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13686
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013687set maxconn global <maxconn>
13688 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13689 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13690 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13691 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13692 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13693 setting.
13694
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013695set rate-limit connections global <value>
13696 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13697 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13698 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13699 is passed in number of connections per second.
13700
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013701set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13702 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13703 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013704 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13705 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013706
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013707set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13708 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13709 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13710 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13711 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13712
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013713set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13714 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13715 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13716 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13717 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13718 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13719
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013720set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13721 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13722 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13723 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13724
13725set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13726 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13727 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13728 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13729
13730set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13731 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13732 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13733 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13734 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13735 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13736 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13737 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13738 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13739
13740set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13741 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13742 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13743
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013744set ssl ocsp-response <response>
13745 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
13746 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
13747 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
13748 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
13749
13750 Example:
13751 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
13752 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
13753 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
13754 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
13755
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013756set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013757 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13758 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13759 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13760 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013761 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13762 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013763
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013764set timeout cli <delay>
13765 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13766 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13767 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13768
13769set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13770 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13771 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013772 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13773 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13774 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13775 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13776 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13777 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13778 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13779 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13780 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13781 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13782 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13783 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13784 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013785
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013786show errors [<iid>]
13787 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13788 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013789 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13790 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13791 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013792
13793 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13794 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13795 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13796 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13797 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13798 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13799 are reported too.
13800
13801 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13802 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13803 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13804 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13805 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13806 code.
13807
13808 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13809 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13810 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13811 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13812 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13813 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13814 line.
13815
13816 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013817 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13818 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013819 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13820 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13821
13822 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13823 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13824 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13825 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13826 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13827 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13828 00204+ minal\r\n
13829 00211 \r\n
13830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013831 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013832 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13833 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13834 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13835 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13836 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13837 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013838
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013839show info
13840 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13841
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013842show map [<map>]
13843 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013844 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13845 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13846 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13847 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13848 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13849 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013850
13851show acl [<acl>]
13852 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013853 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13854 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13855 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13856 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13857 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013858
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013859show pools
13860 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13861 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13862 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13863 the pools.
13864
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013865show sess
13866 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013867 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13868 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13869
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013870show sess <id>
13871 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13872 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13873 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13874 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13875 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Oliviere99d44d2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020013876 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
13877 returned in src/dumpstats.c
13878
13879 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
13880 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013881
13882show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13883 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13884 possible to dump only selected items :
13885 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13886 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13887 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13888 for example:
13889 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13890 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13891 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13892
13893 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013894 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13895 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013896 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13897 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13898 Nbproc: 1
13899 Process_num: 1
13900 (...)
13901
13902 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13903 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13904 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13905 (...)
13906 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13907
13908 $
13909
13910 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13911 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13912 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13913 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013914 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013915
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013916show table
13917 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13918 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13919 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13920 entries currently in use.
13921
13922 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013923 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013924 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13925 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013926
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013927show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013928 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13929 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13930 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013931 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13932
13933 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13934 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13935 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13936 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13937 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13938
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013939 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13940 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13941 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13942 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13943 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13944 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13945
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013946
13947 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013948 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13949 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013950
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013951 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013952 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013953 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013954 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13955 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13956 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13957 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013958
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013959 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013960 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013961 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13962 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013963
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013964 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13965 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013966 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013967 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13968 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013969
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013970 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13971 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013972 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013973 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13974 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13975
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013976 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13977 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13978 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13979 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13980 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13981
13982 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13983 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13984 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013985 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13986 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013987 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13988 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013989
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013990shutdown frontend <frontend>
13991 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13992 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13993 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13994 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13995 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13996 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13997 once it is terminated.
13998
13999 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14000 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14001
14002 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14003 level "admin".
14004
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020014005shutdown session <id>
14006 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
14007 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14008 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
14009 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
14010 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
14011 flag in the logs.
14012
Cyril Bontéde9789b2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020014013shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014014 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14015 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14016 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14017 'K' flag in the logs.
14018
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014019/*
14020 * Local variables:
14021 * fill-column: 79
14022 * End:
14023 */